1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H 2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H 3 /* 4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header 5 * 6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net> 8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com> 9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch> 10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com> 11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com> 12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com> 13 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2022 Intel Corporation 15 * 16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any 17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above 18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. 19 * 20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES 21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF 22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR 23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES 24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN 25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF 26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. 27 * 28 */ 29 30 /* 31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please 32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so 33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI. 34 * 35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in 36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there 37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are 38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API 39 * can actually be identified and removed. 40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file. 41 */ 42 43 #include <linux/types.h> 44 45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211" 46 47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG "config" 48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN "scan" 49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG "regulatory" 50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME "mlme" 51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR "vendor" 52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN "nan" 53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE "testmode" 54 55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN 4 56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX 15 57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN 1 58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX 0x3c /* 0b00111100 */ 59 60 /** 61 * DOC: Station handling 62 * 63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN 64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved 65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN). 66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added 67 * to. 68 * 69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's 70 * capabilities. 71 * 72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS 73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows: 74 * - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate 75 * or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions 76 * - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid 77 * to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same 78 * time mark it authorized. 79 * - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used 80 * - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down 81 * the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK) 82 * 83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types 84 */ 85 86 /** 87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support 88 * 89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace 90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames 91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example, 92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel 93 * for various reasons. 94 * 95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations 96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to 97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a 98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those 99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the 100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility 101 * for doing that. 102 * 103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the 104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy 105 * attributes so applications know what to expect. 106 * 107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active, 108 * these registrations are ignored until the interface type is 109 * changed again. This means that changing the interface type can 110 * lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but 111 * any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they 112 * will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames. 113 * 114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required 115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking, 116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its 117 * status is indicated to the sending socket. 118 * 119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions 120 * below. 121 */ 122 123 /** 124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities 125 * 126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have 127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this 128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions 129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported. 130 * 131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in 132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the 133 * types there no concurrency is implied. 134 * 135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed: 136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in 137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's 138 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and 139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN 140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list 141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute. 142 * 143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is 144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically, 145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the 146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of 147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions 148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported 149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially 150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 151 * 152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual 153 * interfaces that a given device supports. 154 */ 155 156 /** 157 * DOC: packet coalesce support 158 * 159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast 160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the 161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing 162 * and power consumption. 163 * 164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts 165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some 166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the 167 * following events occur. 168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum 169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule. 170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit. 171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules. 172 * 173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce 174 * rule. 175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay 176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched 177 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match' 178 * Multiple such rules can be created. 179 */ 180 181 /** 182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload 183 * 184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers 185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no 189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 191 * 192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be 193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL 194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to 195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have 196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this 197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is 198 * not present. 199 * 200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers 201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no 205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 207 * 208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also 210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided. 211 */ 212 213 /** 214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload 215 * 216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by 217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the 219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and 220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional 221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in 222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS. 223 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai 224 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai 225 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message 226 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK 227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and 228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA. 229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used 230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696. 231 * 232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the 233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting 234 * up a connection or after roaming. 235 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal 236 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges 237 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated 238 * %Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace 239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used 240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also. 241 * 242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS 243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the 244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and 245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based 246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with 247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to 248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching. 249 */ 250 251 /** 252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload 253 * 254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station 256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by 257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode. 258 * 259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in 260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode 261 * respectively. 262 */ 263 264 /** 265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs 266 * 267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a 269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs 270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet 271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are 272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through 273 * that main netdev. 274 * 275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and 276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using 277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID. 278 */ 279 280 /** 281 * DOC: TID configuration 282 * 283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG 284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities. 285 * 286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in 287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the 288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG. 289 * 290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC 291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the 292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except 293 * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if 294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values 295 * will be overwritten. 296 * 297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection 298 * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back 299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when 300 * the interface goes down. 301 */ 302 303 /** 304 * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload 305 * 306 * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode. 307 * 308 * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting 309 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 310 * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt 311 * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai. 312 * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace. 313 * 314 * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the 315 * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association 316 * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters 317 * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 318 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA 319 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption 320 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption 321 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 322 * 323 * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data. 324 */ 325 326 /** 327 * DOC: Multi-Link Operation 328 * 329 * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between to MLDs utilizes multiple 330 * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need 331 * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute. 332 * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link 333 * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to 334 * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions. 335 */ 336 337 /** 338 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands 339 * 340 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors 341 * 342 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request 343 * to get a list of all present wiphys. 344 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or 345 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 346 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 347 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the 348 * channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel), 349 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 350 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or 351 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD. However, for setting the channel, 352 * see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward 353 * compatibility only. 354 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request 355 * or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and 356 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 357 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes 358 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 359 * 360 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration; 361 * either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a 362 * single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported. 363 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires 364 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE. 365 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response 366 * to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 367 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also 368 * be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface, 369 * then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and 370 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME. 371 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes 372 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from 373 * userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires 374 * attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are 375 * enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 376 * and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all 377 * the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well. 378 * 379 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified 380 * by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 381 * represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key, 382 * the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 383 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 384 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD. 385 * For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by 386 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 387 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 388 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 389 * and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents 390 * peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO 391 * group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 392 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX 393 * or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address 394 * for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by 395 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 396 * 397 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used) 398 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface 399 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL 400 * attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses 401 * internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE, 402 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP. 403 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters 404 * are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that 405 * do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 406 * %NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 407 * %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE, 408 * %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 409 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 410 * %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 411 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS. 412 * The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the 413 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the 414 * attributes determining channel width. 415 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 416 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface 417 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP 418 * 419 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by 420 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 421 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by 422 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 423 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the 424 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 425 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 426 * or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified 427 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in 428 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and 429 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type 430 * of disconnection indication should be sent to the station 431 * (Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that 432 * frame). 433 * 434 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to 435 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 436 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 437 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH: Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to 438 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 439 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 440 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by 441 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP. 442 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by 443 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 444 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the 445 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 446 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 447 * or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified 448 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 449 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by 450 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 451 * 452 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set 453 * regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device 454 * has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the 455 * global regdomain will be returned. 456 * A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the 457 * regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel 458 * information will still be mended according to further hints from 459 * the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API 460 * is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as 461 * all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it). 462 * If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then 463 * its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory 464 * core is not used to help with compliance in this case. 465 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command 466 * after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory 467 * domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our 468 * current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides 469 * NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each 470 * regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes given by 471 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and 472 * %NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by 473 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and 474 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP. 475 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain 476 * to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will 477 * store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it. 478 * 479 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the 480 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 481 * 482 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the 483 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 484 * 485 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The 486 * interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management 487 * frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be 488 * added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with 489 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be 490 * added to all specified management frames generated by 491 * kernel/firmware/driver. 492 * Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this 493 * point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this 494 * command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the 495 * option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 496 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 497 * NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 498 * 499 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results 500 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters 501 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 502 * probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to 503 * specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will 504 * be used. 505 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to 506 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group) 507 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons, 508 * partial scan results may be available 509 * 510 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain 511 * intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by 512 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is 513 * not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified, 514 * scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval. 515 * These attributes are mutually exculsive, 516 * i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if 517 * NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined. 518 * If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan 519 * plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet). 520 * Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS) 521 * are passed, they are used in the probe requests. For 522 * broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty 523 * string). If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and 524 * a passive scan is performed. %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 525 * if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not 526 * passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain 527 * are used. Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by 528 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute. The first cycle of the 529 * scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY 530 * is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled 531 * scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute 532 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it. 533 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if 534 * scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon 535 * as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again. 536 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan 537 * results available. 538 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has 539 * stopped. The driver may issue this event at any time during a 540 * scheduled scan. One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware 541 * does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running 542 * a scheduled scan. This event is also sent when the 543 * %NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface 544 * is brought down while a scheduled scan was running. 545 * 546 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation 547 * or noise level 548 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to 549 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group) 550 * 551 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 552 * (for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 553 * (PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or 554 * using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 555 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS 556 * authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier 557 * advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an 558 * ESS. 559 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 560 * (for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 561 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS 562 * authentication. 563 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries. 564 * 565 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain 566 * has been changed and provides details of the request information 567 * that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request 568 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx 569 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if 570 * the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or 571 * %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain 572 * set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is 573 * %NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on 574 * to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2). 575 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon 576 * has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or 577 * any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel 578 * where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example 579 * if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your 580 * driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while 581 * doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not 582 * on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP 583 * or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will 584 * never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always 585 * enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had 586 * either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to 587 * userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from 588 * (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred 589 * before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER) 590 * the beacon hint was processed. 591 * 592 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification. 593 * This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and 594 * as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the 595 * authentication process. 596 * When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the 597 * interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and 598 * BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify 599 * the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication 600 * request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ + 601 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the 602 * channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the 603 * authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs 604 * (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added 605 * to the frame. 606 * When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication 607 * frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the 608 * frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct 609 * state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the 610 * MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The 611 * included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame 612 * (including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is 613 * also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that 614 * case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a 615 * %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which 616 * pending authentication timed out). 617 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like 618 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation 619 * (similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request, 620 * MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The 621 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the 622 * request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not 623 * included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is 624 * included). 625 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like 626 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to 627 * MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication 628 * primitives). 629 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like 630 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to 631 * MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives). 632 * 633 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael 634 * MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the 635 * event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of 636 * the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key 637 * type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and 638 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this 639 * event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive 640 * 641 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a 642 * FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found) 643 * and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those 644 * should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be 645 * executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ 646 * may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval, 647 * given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not 648 * given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms). 649 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is 650 * determined by the network interface. 651 * 652 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute 653 * to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through 654 * to the driver. 655 * 656 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command 657 * requests to connect to a specified network but without separating 658 * auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a 659 * %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association 660 * IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 661 * %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 662 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 663 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 664 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 665 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and 666 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT. 667 * If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are 668 * restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming 669 * within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT 670 * can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while 671 * allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to 672 * ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one 673 * set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing 674 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict 675 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT). 676 * Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if 677 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is 678 * included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user 679 * space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends 680 * up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g. 681 * userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the 682 * driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE 683 * has to get updated with the apt PMKID). 684 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within 685 * the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with 686 * a different BSS is desired. 687 * Background scan period can optionally be 688 * specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 689 * if not specified default background scan configuration 690 * in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled. 691 * This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan. 692 * It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the 693 * connection is established or failed to be established. This can be 694 * determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success, 695 * non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the 696 * event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate 697 * authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP. 698 * Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as 699 * well to remain backwards compatible. 700 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself. 701 * When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using 702 * fast transition, this event should be followed by an 703 * %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event. 704 * Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue 705 * %NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the 706 * new BSS the card/driver roamed to. 707 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify 708 * userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other 709 * reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and 710 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used. 711 * 712 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices 713 * associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow. 714 * 715 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified 716 * channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do 717 * off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for 718 * a response while being associated to an AP on another channel. 719 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus 720 * radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the 721 * frequency for the operation. 722 * %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds 723 * to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to 724 * notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the 725 * driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the 726 * radio). 727 * When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 728 * that will be included with any events pertaining to this request; 729 * the cookie is also used to cancel the request. 730 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a 731 * pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been 732 * completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration. 733 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the 734 * radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to 735 * uniquely identify the request. 736 * This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested 737 * remain-on-channel duration has expired. 738 * 739 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX 740 * rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface 741 * and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates. 742 * 743 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames 744 * (via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command 745 * requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for 746 * backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames) 747 * and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame 748 * that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or 749 * four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration 750 * cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink 751 * socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made. 752 * The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if 753 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which 754 * case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the 755 * flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it. 756 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for 757 * backward compatibility 758 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This 759 * command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and 760 * as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in 761 * kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a 762 * user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 763 * frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used 764 * to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was 765 * received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel 766 * or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel 767 * and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time 768 * specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation 769 * returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the 770 * TX status event pertaining to the TX request. 771 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 772 * management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band. 773 * %NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA 774 * counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute 775 * is used during CSA period. 776 * For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be 777 * specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses 778 * in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by 779 * lower layers. 780 * For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 781 * indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may 782 * be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp. 783 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this 784 * command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait 785 * time if it is known that it is no longer necessary. This command is 786 * also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel 787 * wait time. 788 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility. 789 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame 790 * transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies 791 * the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the 792 * frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged 793 * the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the 794 * tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 795 * indicate the ack RX timestamp. 796 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for 797 * backward compatibility. 798 * 799 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 800 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 801 * 802 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command 803 * is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger 804 * levels. 805 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This 806 * command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was 807 * reached. 808 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 809 * and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface 810 * (identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on. 811 * In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism 812 * with which it switches channels is implementation-defined. 813 * When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while 814 * no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation 815 * of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take 816 * precedence when they are used. 817 * 818 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface 819 * (no longer supported). 820 * 821 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform 822 * multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets 823 * with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header) 824 * will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast) 825 * MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may 826 * break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop 827 * unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability 828 * to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases. 829 * This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of 830 * type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces 831 * (%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode. 832 * If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this 833 * command, the feature is disabled. 834 * 835 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial 836 * mesh config parameters may be given. 837 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the 838 * network is determined by the network interface. 839 * 840 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame 841 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 842 * deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 843 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame 844 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 845 * disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 846 * 847 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a 848 * beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer. This is only 849 * sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer 850 * candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 851 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or 852 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set. On reception of this 853 * notification, userspace may decide to create a new station 854 * (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). To stop this notification from 855 * reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the 856 * new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later 857 * depending on the authentication result. 858 * 859 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 860 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 861 * Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports 862 * various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this 863 * command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For 864 * more background information, see 865 * https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN. 866 * The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification 867 * from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the 868 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason 869 * for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present 870 * in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the 871 * wakeup but reports that it was woken up. 872 * 873 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver 874 * the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This 875 * feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data 876 * is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and 877 * contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened, 878 * this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to 879 * inform userspace of the new replay counter. 880 * 881 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace 882 * of PMKSA caching dandidates. 883 * 884 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup). 885 * In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take 886 * actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one). 887 * In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested 888 * operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and 889 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with 890 * %NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN). 891 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The 892 * %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be 893 * sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as 894 * 802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012 895 * 8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently 896 * supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES 897 * and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in 898 * &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode. 899 * 900 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP 901 * (or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to 902 * implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3 903 * frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame 904 * is received. 905 * For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and 906 * other attributes like the interface index are present. 907 * If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can 908 * only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription 909 * is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events. 910 * 911 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the 912 * associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame 913 * and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly 914 * to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener. 915 * 916 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface 917 * by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is 918 * acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses 919 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a 920 * direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match 921 * up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and 922 * has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed. 923 * 924 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from 925 * other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement 926 * OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME 927 * messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register. 928 * 929 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether 930 * No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied. 931 * 932 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels 933 * independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating 934 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the 935 * attributes determining channel width. This indication may also be 936 * sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA 937 * from the remote AP) is completed; 938 * 939 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch 940 * has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator 941 * (ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or 942 * initiated on our own). It indicates that 943 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 944 * after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's. The userspace may 945 * decide to react to this indication by requesting other 946 * interfaces to change channel as well. 947 * 948 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by 949 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with 950 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the 951 * P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and 952 * public action frame TX. 953 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by 954 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. 955 * 956 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to 957 * notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a 958 * station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON 959 * is used for this. 960 * 961 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames 962 * for IBSS or MESH vif. 963 * 964 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control. 965 * This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC 966 * address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in 967 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in 968 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it 969 * is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver 970 * will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This 971 * command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its 972 * ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP. 973 * 974 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once 975 * a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished 976 * or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with 977 * this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars 978 * while operating on this channel. 979 * %NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the 980 * event. 981 * 982 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features, 983 * i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features. 984 * Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap. 985 * 986 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition 987 * Information Element to the WLAN driver 988 * 989 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver 990 * to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along 991 * with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report 992 * received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE). 993 * 994 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running 995 * a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to 996 * complete. 997 * 998 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can 999 * return back to normal. 1000 * 1001 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules. 1002 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules. 1003 * 1004 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the 1005 * new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA) 1006 * in the beacon for some time (as defined in the 1007 * %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the 1008 * new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using 1009 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel 1010 * width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform 1011 * other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel 1012 * switch is complete. 1013 * 1014 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified 1015 * by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in 1016 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in 1017 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 1018 * For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is 1019 * used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions 1020 * (&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands. 1021 * This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes. 1022 * 1023 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values. 1024 * The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If 1025 * that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this 1026 * QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an 1027 * association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart. 1028 * 1029 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given 1030 * %NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO 1031 * and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters. 1032 * Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by 1033 * userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets 1034 * up the TX TS in the driver/device. 1035 * If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks 1036 * if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to 1037 * avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would 1038 * make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still 1039 * fail even if the check was successful. 1040 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID 1041 * and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this 1042 * before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating 1043 * or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case. 1044 * 1045 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to 1046 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 1047 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 1048 * 1049 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and 1050 * bandwidth of a channel must be given. 1051 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the 1052 * network is determined by the network interface. 1053 * 1054 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer, 1055 * identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is 1056 * provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining 1057 * channel width/type. The target operating class is given via 1058 * %NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS. 1059 * The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching 1060 * operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the 1061 * AP. 1062 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS 1063 * peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel 1064 * when this command completes. 1065 * 1066 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used 1067 * as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom 1068 * management. 1069 * 1070 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is 1071 * not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through 1072 * cfg80211_scan_done(). 1073 * 1074 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its 1075 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been 1076 * previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it 1077 * has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a 1078 * cluster. This command must have a valid 1079 * %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional 1080 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is 1081 * omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will 1082 * decide what to use. After this command NAN functions can be 1083 * added. 1084 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by 1085 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. 1086 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined 1087 * with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this 1088 * operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id 1089 * (%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 1090 * of the function upon success. 1091 * Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right 1092 * way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination 1093 * event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new 1094 * function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one 1095 * which just terminated. 1096 * This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command 1097 * returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes 1098 * the response to this command. 1099 * Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well. 1100 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie. 1101 * This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is 1102 * terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID 1103 * and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes. 1104 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN 1105 * configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN 1106 * was executed). It must contain at least one of the following 1107 * attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 1108 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the 1109 * current configuration is not changed. If it is present but 1110 * set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care 1111 * (i.e. the device can decide what to do). 1112 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported. 1113 * This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and 1114 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE. 1115 * 1116 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters 1117 * for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal 1118 * BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it 1119 * does not result in a change for the current association. Currently, 1120 * only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command. 1121 * 1122 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0 1123 * for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1124 * When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the 1125 * PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK. 1126 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously 1127 * configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by 1128 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 1129 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was 1130 * completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload 1131 * should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with 1132 * %NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT 1133 * should be indicated instead. 1134 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request 1135 * and RX notification. This command is used both as a request to transmit 1136 * a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame 1137 * has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 1138 * frame contents. The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or 1139 * 802.11 headers. 1140 * For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and 1141 * its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known 1142 * to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit 1143 * the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both 1144 * the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link 1145 * address of that link. 1146 * When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 1147 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added 1148 * indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame 1149 * was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively. 1150 * 1151 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded. 1152 * 1153 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host 1154 * drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and 1155 * association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen. 1156 * This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space) 1157 * to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to 1158 * driver) to indicate the authentication status. 1159 * 1160 * User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to 1161 * trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses 1162 * this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user 1163 * space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user 1164 * space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds 1165 * further with the association after getting successful authentication 1166 * status. User space indicates the authentication status through 1167 * %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH 1168 * command interface. 1169 * 1170 * Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in 1171 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO 1172 * during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD 1173 * APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability 1174 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling 1175 * MLO during the authentication offload or not. 1176 * User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it 1177 * receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User 1178 * space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request 1179 * doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable. 1180 * User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and 1181 * interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD 1182 * address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and 1183 * BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the 1184 * MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the 1185 * authentication. 1186 * 1187 * Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the 1188 * user space through the connect result as the user space would have 1189 * initiated the connection through the connect request. 1190 * 1191 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's 1192 * ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 1193 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its 1194 * address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1195 * 1196 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in 1197 * the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute. 1198 * 1199 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s) 1200 * with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested 1201 * %NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address 1202 * randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the 1203 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes. 1204 * If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute. 1205 * A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in 1206 * the netlink extended ack message. 1207 * 1208 * To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it. 1209 * 1210 * Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the 1211 * measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they 1212 * become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket 1213 * buffer size. 1214 * 1215 * Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start 1216 * multiple concurrent measurements. 1217 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the 1218 * result notification from the driver to the requesting socket. 1219 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that 1220 * the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie 1221 * (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE). 1222 * 1223 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was 1224 * detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel 1225 * indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes 1226 * determining the width and type. 1227 * 1228 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to 1229 * offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support 1230 * OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely 1231 * on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode. 1232 * 1233 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric 1234 * refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data 1235 * frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a 1236 * primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of 1237 * the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some 1238 * form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be 1239 * properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the 1240 * regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data 1241 * so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for 1242 * rate selection. 1243 * 1244 * Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh 1245 * peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame 1246 * content. The frame is ethernet data. 1247 * 1248 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration 1249 * is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute. 1250 * 1251 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon 1252 * frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was 1253 * dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon 1254 * protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 1255 * 1256 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control 1257 * port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. 1258 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 1259 * includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included 1260 * if the recipient acknowledged the frame. 1261 * 1262 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is 1263 * passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to 1264 * specify the wiphy index to be applied to. 1265 * 1266 * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever 1267 * mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision. 1268 * 1269 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that 1270 * userspace wants to change the BSS color. 1271 * 1272 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has 1273 * started 1274 * 1275 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has 1276 * been aborted 1277 * 1278 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change 1279 * has completed 1280 * 1281 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using - 1282 * &NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address 1283 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK 1284 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces 1285 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 1286 * 1287 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association 1288 * temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 1289 * to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to 1290 * specify the timeout value. 1291 * 1292 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The 1293 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link. 1294 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come 1295 * without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links 1296 * in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP. 1297 * 1298 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station 1299 * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station 1300 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station 1301 * 1302 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number 1303 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use 1304 */ 1305 enum nl80211_commands { 1306 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 1307 NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC, 1308 1309 NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, /* can dump */ 1310 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY, 1311 NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY, 1312 NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY, 1313 1314 NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE, /* can dump */ 1315 NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE, 1316 NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE, 1317 NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE, 1318 1319 NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY, 1320 NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY, 1321 NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY, 1322 NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY, 1323 1324 NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON, 1325 NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, 1326 NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1327 NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1328 NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1329 NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1330 1331 NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, 1332 NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION, 1333 NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, 1334 NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION, 1335 1336 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, 1337 NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH, 1338 NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH, 1339 NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH, 1340 1341 NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS, 1342 1343 NL80211_CMD_SET_REG, 1344 NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG, 1345 1346 NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG, 1347 NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG, 1348 1349 NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */, 1350 1351 NL80211_CMD_GET_REG, 1352 1353 NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN, 1354 NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 1355 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS, 1356 NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED, 1357 1358 NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, 1359 1360 NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, 1361 NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 1362 NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1363 NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, 1364 1365 NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE, 1366 1367 NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT, 1368 1369 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS, 1370 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS, 1371 1372 NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 1373 1374 NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, 1375 NL80211_CMD_ROAM, 1376 NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT, 1377 1378 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS, 1379 1380 NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, 1381 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS, 1382 1383 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA, 1384 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA, 1385 NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA, 1386 1387 NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1388 NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1389 1390 NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK, 1391 1392 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1393 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1394 NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1395 NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1396 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1397 NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1398 1399 NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE, 1400 NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE, 1401 1402 NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM, 1403 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM, 1404 1405 NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL, 1406 NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER, 1407 1408 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL, 1409 1410 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH, 1411 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH, 1412 1413 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1414 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE, 1415 1416 NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE, 1417 1418 NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN, 1419 NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN, 1420 1421 NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN, 1422 NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN, 1423 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS, 1424 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED, 1425 1426 NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD, 1427 1428 NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 1429 1430 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER, 1431 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT, 1432 1433 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME, 1434 1435 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT, 1436 1437 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS, 1438 1439 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME, 1440 1441 NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP, 1442 1443 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY, 1444 1445 NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE, 1446 NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE, 1447 1448 NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED, 1449 1450 NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE, 1451 1452 NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, 1453 1454 NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT, 1455 1456 NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 1457 1458 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES, 1459 NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT, 1460 1461 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START, 1462 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP, 1463 1464 NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE, 1465 NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE, 1466 1467 NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1468 1469 NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 1470 1471 NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP, 1472 1473 NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS, 1474 NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS, 1475 1476 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP, 1477 1478 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB, 1479 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB, 1480 1481 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY, 1482 1483 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1484 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1485 1486 NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE, 1487 1488 NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN, 1489 1490 NL80211_CMD_START_NAN, 1491 NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN, 1492 NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION, 1493 NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION, 1494 NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, 1495 NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH, 1496 1497 NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST, 1498 1499 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS, 1500 1501 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK, 1502 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK, 1503 1504 NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 1505 1506 NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB, 1507 1508 NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH, 1509 1510 NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED, 1511 1512 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME, 1513 1514 NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 1515 1516 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START, 1517 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT, 1518 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE, 1519 1520 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR, 1521 1522 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO, 1523 1524 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK, 1525 1526 NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG, 1527 1528 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON, 1529 1530 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1531 1532 NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS, 1533 1534 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 1535 1536 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST, 1537 1538 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 1539 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 1540 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 1541 1542 NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD, 1543 1544 NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK, 1545 1546 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK, 1547 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK, 1548 1549 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA, 1550 NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA, 1551 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA, 1552 1553 /* add new commands above here */ 1554 1555 /* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */ 1556 __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST, 1557 NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1 1558 }; 1559 1560 /* 1561 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them 1562 * here 1563 */ 1564 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS 1565 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE 1566 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE 1567 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE 1568 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1569 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE 1570 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE 1571 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT 1572 1573 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 1574 1575 /* source-level API compatibility */ 1576 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG 1577 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG 1578 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE 1579 1580 /** 1581 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes 1582 * 1583 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors 1584 * 1585 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf. 1586 * /sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index 1587 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming) 1588 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters 1589 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz, 1590 * defines the channel together with the (deprecated) 1591 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes 1592 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 1593 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 1594 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values 1595 * of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the 1596 * documentation of the enum for more information. 1597 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the 1598 * channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the 1599 * operating channel center frequency. 1600 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the 1601 * channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth 1602 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 1603 * if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included): 1604 * NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including 1605 * this attribute) 1606 * NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only 1607 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel 1608 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel 1609 * This attribute is now deprecated. 1610 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1611 * less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1612 * dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8 1613 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1614 * greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1615 * dot11ShortLongLimit; u8 1616 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum 1617 * length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable 1618 * fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32 1619 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length 1620 * larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range: 1621 * 0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32 1622 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11 1623 * section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8 1624 * 1625 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on 1626 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name 1627 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype 1628 * 1629 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices 1630 * that don't have a netdev (u64) 1631 * 1632 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses) 1633 * 1634 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 1635 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 1636 * keys 1637 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 1638 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 1639 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 1640 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 1641 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 1642 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key 1643 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the 1644 * default management key 1645 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or 1646 * other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used 1647 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or 1648 * other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used 1649 * 1650 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU 1651 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing 1652 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE 1653 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE 1654 * 1655 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16) 1656 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1657 * &enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2) 1658 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by 1659 * IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16). 1660 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported 1661 * rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1662 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1663 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station 1664 * to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to. 1665 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info 1666 * given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing 1667 * info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info. 1668 * 1669 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands, 1670 * consisting of a nested array. 1671 * 1672 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes). 1673 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link 1674 * (see &enum nl80211_plink_action). 1675 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path. 1676 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path 1677 * info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at 1678 * &enum nl80211_mpath_info. 1679 * 1680 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1681 * &enum nl80211_mntr_flags. 1682 * 1683 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the 1684 * current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to. 1685 * For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel 1686 * to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can 1687 * also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set 1688 * regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the 1689 * IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country. 1690 * Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain 1691 * to a specific alpha2. 1692 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory 1693 * rules. 1694 * 1695 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1) 1696 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1697 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1698 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled 1699 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1700 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic 1701 * rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1702 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1703 * 1704 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from 1705 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 1706 * 1707 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all 1708 * supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number 1709 * of the interface mode. 1710 * 1711 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for 1712 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE. 1713 * 1714 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with 1715 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE). 1716 * 1717 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with 1718 * a single scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1719 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can 1720 * scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1721 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements 1722 * that can be added to a scan request 1723 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information 1724 * elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request 1725 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be 1726 * used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute. 1727 * 1728 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz) 1729 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive 1730 * scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan 1731 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS 1732 * 1733 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain 1734 * currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_* 1735 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently 1736 * set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*) 1737 * 1738 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies 1739 * an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number) 1740 * that the driver for the given wiphy supports. 1741 * 1742 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header 1743 * and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and 1744 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events 1745 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets) 1746 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type, 1747 * represented as a u32 1748 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and 1749 * %NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16 1750 * 1751 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as 1752 * a u32 1753 * 1754 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1755 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1756 * the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This 1757 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1758 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1759 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1760 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1761 * the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This 1762 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1763 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1764 * 1765 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported 1766 * cipher suites 1767 * 1768 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look 1769 * for other networks on different channels 1770 * 1771 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this 1772 * is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event 1773 * 1774 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is 1775 * used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32); 1776 * this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 1777 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for 1778 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it 1779 * must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not. 1780 * Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will 1781 * let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not. 1782 * 1783 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a 1784 * &struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 1785 * 1786 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls 1787 * IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in 1788 * station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1789 * request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until 1790 * authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by 1791 * default in station mode. 1792 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the 1793 * ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be 1794 * specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not 1795 * specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This 1796 * attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to 1797 * indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported. 1798 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with 1799 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom 1800 * ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted. 1801 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control 1802 * port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE) 1803 * will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211 1804 * socket. If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending 1805 * control port frames directly to the network interface is used. If the 1806 * flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead 1807 * using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. If control port routing over NL80211 is 1808 * to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 1809 * flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth 1810 * frames are not forwared over the control port. 1811 * 1812 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver. 1813 * We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this. 1814 * 1815 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT 1816 * event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to 1817 * a local disconnect request. 1818 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 1819 * event (u16) 1820 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating 1821 * that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to 1822 * indicate that the BSS is to use protection. 1823 * 1824 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON 1825 * to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection 1826 * (an array of u32). 1827 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1828 * indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a 1829 * u32). 1830 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1831 * indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using 1832 * (a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions). 1833 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1834 * indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32). 1835 * This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, 1836 * indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which 1837 * implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also 1838 * the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware. 1839 * If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should 1840 * assume the driver supports all the AKM suites. 1841 * 1842 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as 1843 * sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1844 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as 1845 * sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1846 * 1847 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT 1848 * commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use 1849 * Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the 1850 * Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is 1851 * used for the initial association to an ESS. 1852 * 1853 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with 1854 * %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1855 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect() 1856 * and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each 1857 * with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1858 * 1859 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace. 1860 * 1861 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for 1862 * dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being 1863 * dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has 1864 * obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that 1865 * all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it 1866 * changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated 1867 * completely from scratch. 1868 * 1869 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface 1870 * 1871 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of 1872 * the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute 1873 * containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info. 1874 * 1875 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching. 1876 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can 1877 * cache, a wiphy attribute. 1878 * 1879 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32. 1880 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that 1881 * specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the 1882 * remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32. 1883 * 1884 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects. 1885 * 1886 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes 1887 * (enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The 1888 * enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested 1889 * data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all 1890 * rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute 1891 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP, 1892 * and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must 1893 * specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon. 1894 * The driver must also specify support for this with the extended 1895 * features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 1896 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 1897 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and 1898 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE. 1899 * 1900 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain 1901 * at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME. 1902 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the 1903 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command. 1904 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1905 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1906 * information about which frame types can be transmitted with 1907 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 1908 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1909 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1910 * information about which frame types can be registered for RX. 1911 * 1912 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was 1913 * acknowledged by the recipient. 1914 * 1915 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values. 1916 * 1917 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a 1918 * nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes. 1919 * 1920 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command 1921 * is requesting a local authentication/association state change without 1922 * invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with 1923 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1924 * NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 1925 * 1926 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations 1927 * connected to this BSS. 1928 * 1929 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See 1930 * &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values. 1931 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units. 1932 * This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING 1933 * for non-automatic settings. 1934 * 1935 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly 1936 * means support for per-station GTKs. 1937 * 1938 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting. 1939 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1940 * not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this 1941 * bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna. 1942 * 1943 * Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first 1944 * bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n 1945 * drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to 1946 * a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if 1947 * a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not. 1948 * HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be 1949 * derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask. 1950 * Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not. 1951 * Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot 1952 * support by returning -EINVAL. 1953 * 1954 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving. 1955 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1956 * not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap 1957 * the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna. 1958 * For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX. 1959 * 1960 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1961 * for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters. 1962 * 1963 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1964 * for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters. 1965 * 1966 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS 1967 * 1968 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be 1969 * transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match 1970 * the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this 1971 * flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an 1972 * nl80211 capability flag. 1973 * 1974 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16) 1975 * 1976 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 1977 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 1978 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 1979 * 1980 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters. These cannot be 1981 * changed once the mesh is active. 1982 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute 1983 * containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params. 1984 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver 1985 * allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via 1986 * the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag. 1987 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in 1988 * &enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link 1989 * management state machine. @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or 1990 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled. 1991 * 1992 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy 1993 * capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers 1994 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to 1995 * indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also 1996 * used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN 1997 * triggers. 1998 * 1999 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan 2000 * cycles, in msecs. 2001 * 2002 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more 2003 * sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans. Only BSSs 2004 * that match any of the sets will be reported. These are 2005 * pass-thru filter rules. 2006 * For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a 2007 * set. Since not every hardware supports matching all types of 2008 * attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are 2009 * fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be 2010 * able to ignore them by itself. 2011 * Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but 2012 * this is only an optimization and the userspace application 2013 * needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway. 2014 * If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with 2015 * the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID 2016 * is included in the probe request, but the match attributes 2017 * will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned. 2018 * If omitted, no filtering is done. 2019 * 2020 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported 2021 * interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes 2022 * defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 2023 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like 2024 * %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that 2025 * are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to 2026 * any restrictions in their number or combinations. 2027 * 2028 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information 2029 * necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data. 2030 * 2031 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan, 2032 * nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry 2033 * being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but 2034 * without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 2035 * 2036 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon 2037 * and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see 2038 * &enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32 2039 * 2040 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame. 2041 * This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to 2042 * provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the 2043 * driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames. 2044 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association 2045 * Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and 2046 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into 2047 * (Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to 2048 * (Re)Association Request frames. 2049 * 2050 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration 2051 * of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr. 2052 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working 2053 * as AP. 2054 * 2055 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of 2056 * roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low. 2057 * 2058 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching 2059 * candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr. 2060 * 2061 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not 2062 * for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action 2063 * frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space 2064 * applications use this attribute. 2065 * This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and 2066 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands. 2067 * 2068 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup 2069 * request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are 2070 * described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification. 2071 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a 2072 * TDLS conversation between two devices. 2073 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see 2074 * &enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8. 2075 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate 2076 * as a TDLS peer sta. 2077 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown 2078 * procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via 2079 * %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 2080 * used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation. 2081 * 2082 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices 2083 * that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated 2084 * with support for the features listed in this attribute, see 2085 * &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 2086 * 2087 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells 2088 * the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this, 2089 * it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is 2090 * mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime. 2091 * 2092 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from 2093 * &enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information. 2094 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe 2095 * requests while operating in AP-mode. 2096 * This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for 2097 * offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr). 2098 * 2099 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire 2100 * probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out, 2101 * to be filled by the FW. 2102 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable 2103 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2104 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2105 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable 2106 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2107 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2108 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable 2109 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2110 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2111 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the 2112 * ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid. 2113 * Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature. 2114 * The values that may be configured are: 2115 * MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40 2116 * AMPDU density and AMPDU factor. 2117 * All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored 2118 * by the driver as required. The actual values may be seen in 2119 * the station debugfs ht_caps file. 2120 * 2121 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country 2122 * abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps 2123 * to one DFS region. 2124 * 2125 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of 2126 * up to 16 TIDs. 2127 * 2128 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be 2129 * used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support 2130 * to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from 2131 * the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the 2132 * capability to timeout the stations. 2133 * 2134 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int); 2135 * this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to 2136 * received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 2137 * 2138 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds 2139 * or 0 to disable background scan. 2140 * 2141 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from 2142 * userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from 2143 * a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source 2144 * was used to provide the hint. For the different types of 2145 * allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type. 2146 * 2147 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected 2148 * the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason 2149 * enum has different reasons of connection failure. 2150 * 2151 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. 2152 * This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), 2153 * excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the 2154 * Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with 2155 * authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into 2156 * the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the 2157 * initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and 2158 * Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data 2159 * for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition 2160 * consistent. 2161 * 2162 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from 2163 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2164 * 2165 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32) 2166 * 2167 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with 2168 * the START_AP and SET_BSS commands 2169 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the 2170 * START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1; 2171 * if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS 2172 * no change is made. 2173 * 2174 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 2175 * defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode. 2176 * 2177 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy, 2178 * carried in a u32 attribute 2179 * 2180 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for 2181 * MAC ACL. 2182 * 2183 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum 2184 * number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC 2185 * ACL. 2186 * 2187 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace, 2188 * contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32). 2189 * 2190 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2191 * has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See 2192 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information. 2193 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2194 * has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields. 2195 * 2196 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to 2197 * the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD). 2198 * 2199 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are 2200 * advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations 2201 * and PU-APSD. 2202 * 2203 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see 2204 * &enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32. 2205 * 2206 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports 2207 * receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple 2208 * messages, given with wiphy dump message 2209 * 2210 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier 2211 * 2212 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information 2213 * Element 2214 * 2215 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased 2216 * reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16). 2217 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which 2218 * the connection should have increased reliability (u16). 2219 * 2220 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16). 2221 * This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being 2222 * allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to 2223 * update a TDLS peer STA entry. 2224 * 2225 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information. 2226 * 2227 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2228 * until the channel switch event. 2229 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission 2230 * must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch 2231 * operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet 2232 * was requested by the AP. 2233 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information 2234 * for the time while performing a channel switch. 2235 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2236 * switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL). 2237 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2238 * switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP). 2239 * 2240 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32. 2241 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags. 2242 * 2243 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels. 2244 * 2245 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported 2246 * operating classes. 2247 * 2248 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space 2249 * controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in 2250 * %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS 2251 * channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required 2252 * to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the 2253 * IBSS network. 2254 * 2255 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2256 * 5 MHz channel bandwidth. 2257 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2258 * 10 MHz channel bandwidth. 2259 * 2260 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode 2261 * Notification Element based on association request when used with 2262 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when 2263 * %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS); 2264 * u8 attribute. 2265 * 2266 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if 2267 * %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet) 2268 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command 2269 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this 2270 * attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement 2271 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy 2272 * info, containing a nested array of possible events 2273 * 2274 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This 2275 * data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element 2276 * in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97. 2277 * 2278 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS 2279 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS 2280 * 2281 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many 2282 * associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32. 2283 * Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g., 2284 * other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to 2285 * advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt 2286 * to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail. 2287 * 2288 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which 2289 * should be updated when the frame is transmitted. 2290 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum 2291 * supported number of csa counters. 2292 * 2293 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32. 2294 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability. 2295 * 2296 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface 2297 * creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket 2298 * that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed. 2299 * If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be 2300 * owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will 2301 * be stopped when the socket is closed. 2302 * If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the 2303 * regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket 2304 * that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be 2305 * cleared when the socket is closed. 2306 * If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed 2307 * if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN 2308 * notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this 2309 * attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN 2310 * multicast group. 2311 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the 2312 * station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed. 2313 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically 2314 * torn down when the socket is closed. 2315 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be 2316 * automatically torn down when the socket is closed. 2317 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically 2318 * disabled when the socket is closed. 2319 * 2320 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is 2321 * the TDLS link initiator. 2322 * 2323 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection 2324 * shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be 2325 * used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. 2326 * User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the 2327 * underlying device supports these minimal RRM features: 2328 * %NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES, 2329 * %NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET, 2330 * Or, if global RRM is supported, see: 2331 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM 2332 * If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the 2333 * association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability 2334 * flag in the association request's Capability Info field. 2335 * 2336 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout 2337 * estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack 2338 * %NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower 2339 * drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled 2340 * setting valid value for coverage class. 2341 * 2342 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute) 2343 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute) 2344 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds 2345 * (per second) (u16 attribute) 2346 * 2347 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see 2348 * &enum nl80211_smps_mode. 2349 * 2350 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class 2351 * 2352 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask 2353 * 2354 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device 2355 * is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain 2356 * obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global 2357 * cfg80211 regdomain. 2358 * 2359 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte 2360 * array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum 2361 * nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the 2362 * least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0 2363 * is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1 2364 * of byte 3 (u8 array). 2365 * 2366 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be 2367 * returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY 2368 * may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio 2369 * statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.) 2370 * For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information 2371 * should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters 2372 * over all channels. 2373 * 2374 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a 2375 * scheduled scan is started. Or the delay before a WoWLAN 2376 * net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the 2377 * system is suspended. This value is a u32, in seconds. 2378 2379 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device 2380 * is operating in an indoor environment. 2381 * 2382 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for 2383 * scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2384 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for 2385 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2386 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in 2387 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2388 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan. 2389 * Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval 2390 * between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely, 2391 * thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval 2392 * between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially. 2393 * Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan. 2394 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate 2395 * in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request 2396 * connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start 2397 * a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only. 2398 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the 2399 * BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains 2400 * attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what 2401 * BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 2402 * it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for 2403 * BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware. 2404 * 2405 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported 2406 * or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status 2407 * 2408 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 2409 * 2410 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes: 2411 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 2412 * %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and 2413 * other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO, 2414 * %NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are 2415 * present. 2416 * 2417 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO 2418 * groupID for monitor mode. 2419 * The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each 2420 * group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved), 2421 * each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in 2422 * that group and 0 for not being a member. 2423 * The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for 2424 * each group. 2425 * (smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger 2426 * group numbers on least significant bits.) 2427 * This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode. 2428 * Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO 2429 * groupID data. 2430 * to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero. 2431 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow 2432 * when using MU-MIMO air sniffer. 2433 * to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address 2434 * (e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF) 2435 * 2436 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually 2437 * started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that 2438 * requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this 2439 * attribute must not be included). 2440 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which 2441 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set. 2442 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If 2443 * %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the 2444 * maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with 2445 * measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN 2446 * if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement. 2447 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates 2448 * that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is 2449 * mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration 2450 * and the actual measurement duration may be shorter. 2451 * 2452 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is 2453 * used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state. 2454 * 2455 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by 2456 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with 2457 * %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0. 2458 * Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and 2459 * should not be used during a normal device operation. 2460 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration. This is a u32 2461 * bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum 2462 * nl80211_band. For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 2463 * would be set. This attribute is used with 2464 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and 2465 * it is optional. If no bands are set, it means don't-care and 2466 * the device will decide what to use. 2467 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See 2468 * &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested 2469 * attribute. 2470 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute. 2471 * See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes. 2472 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame 2473 * protection. 2474 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association 2475 * Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet 2476 * STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2477 * 2478 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast 2479 * packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute). 2480 * 2481 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also 2482 * used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID. 2483 * 2484 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which 2485 * other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current 2486 * connected BSS so that they get reported to user space. 2487 * This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to 2488 * other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than 2489 * the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid 2490 * unnecessary wakeups. 2491 * 2492 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in 2493 * the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 2494 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out 2495 * better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure 2496 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 2497 * 2498 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out. 2499 * u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used, 2500 * e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event. 2501 * 2502 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) 2503 * username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with 2504 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2505 * 2506 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part 2507 * of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with 2508 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2509 * 2510 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number 2511 * to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data 2512 * for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2513 * 2514 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the 2515 * NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and 2516 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK 2517 * from successful FILS authentication and is used with 2518 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2519 * 2520 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP 2521 * identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with 2522 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA. 2523 * 2524 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with 2525 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID. 2526 * For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide 2527 * PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X 2528 * authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT 2529 * support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME 2530 * is included as well. 2531 * 2532 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to 2533 * indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests. 2534 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled 2535 * scan request that may be active for the device (u32). 2536 * 2537 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include 2538 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it 2539 * wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake. 2540 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT. 2541 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved) 2542 * 2543 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external 2544 * authentication operation (u32 attribute with an 2545 * &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the 2546 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event. 2547 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user 2548 * space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used 2549 * with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver 2550 * may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability 2551 * is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag 2552 * attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use 2553 * %NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS) 2554 * 2555 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated RX_NSS value notified using this 2556 * u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED. 2557 * 2558 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum 2559 * nl80211_txq_stats) 2560 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy. 2561 * The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced. 2562 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the 2563 * TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is 2564 * enforced. 2565 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes 2566 * a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler. 2567 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from 2568 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2569 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2570 * 2571 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include 2572 * in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing 2573 * measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as 2574 * possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr 2575 * 2576 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder 2577 * statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats. 2578 * 2579 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32), 2580 * if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an 2581 * invalid value. 2582 * 2583 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result) 2584 * data, uses nested attributes specified in 2585 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs. 2586 * This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information, 2587 * with the appropriate sub-attributes. 2588 * 2589 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime 2590 * scheduler. 2591 * 2592 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for 2593 * station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for 2594 * possible values. 2595 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This 2596 * allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included, 2597 * the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver 2598 * should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface 2599 * or per-station. 2600 * 2601 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It 2602 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading 2603 * SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks. 2604 * 2605 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support. 2606 * 2607 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection 2608 * functionality. 2609 * 2610 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 2611 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 2612 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute) 2613 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 2614 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute) 2615 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 2616 * 2617 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key 2618 * (u16). 2619 * 2620 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings. 2621 * 2622 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry 2623 * using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This 2624 * attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating 2625 * supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in 2626 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not 2627 * advertised for a specific interface type. 2628 * 2629 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a 2630 * nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes; 2631 * on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub- 2632 * attributes. 2633 * 2634 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control 2635 * port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames. 2636 * 2637 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32, 2638 * dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value). 2639 * An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. 2640 * Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the 2641 * configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based 2642 * authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE, 2643 * where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE) 2644 * authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP 2645 * authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall 2646 * result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime. 2647 * 2648 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in 2649 * terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME 2650 * (u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional 2651 * parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the 2652 * driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching) 2653 * after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime 2654 * has expired. 2655 * 2656 * Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA 2657 * entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If 2658 * no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration, 2659 * disassociation is still forced. 2660 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the 2661 * %NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there. 2662 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated 2663 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with 2664 * an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET. 2665 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the 2666 * first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1. 2667 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies 2668 * 2669 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from 2670 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). 2671 * 2672 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS 2673 * discovery. It is a nested attribute, see 2674 * &enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. 2675 * 2676 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure 2677 * unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see 2678 * &enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. 2679 * 2680 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from 2681 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2682 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element 2683 * override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in 2684 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2685 * 2686 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 2687 * derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication. 2688 * This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from 2689 * &enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism. 2690 * 2691 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when 2692 * used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields 2693 * of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related 2694 * sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 2695 * 2696 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and 2697 * disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP 2698 * is desired. 2699 * 2700 * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the 2701 * %NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event. 2702 * 2703 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2704 * until the color switch event. 2705 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are 2706 * switching to 2707 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE 2708 * information for the time while performing a color switch. 2709 * 2710 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID 2711 * advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode. 2712 * Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID 2713 * and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace. 2714 * Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID 2715 * parameters. 2716 * See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details. 2717 * 2718 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements. 2719 * Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID. 2720 * Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces. 2721 * 2722 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain 2723 * available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used 2724 * to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 2725 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 2726 * switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 2727 * radar channel. 2728 * 2729 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags, 2730 * enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be 2731 * used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. 2732 * 2733 * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from 2734 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2735 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2736 * 2737 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with 2738 * various commands that need a link ID to operate. 2739 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some 2740 * per-link information and a link ID. 2741 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as 2742 * authenticate/associate. 2743 * 2744 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO 2745 * connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not 2746 * included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection. 2747 * 2748 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of 2749 * AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 2750 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this 2751 * attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM 2752 * suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum 2753 * number prior to the introduction of this attribute. 2754 * 2755 * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16) 2756 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16) 2757 * 2758 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in 2759 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2760 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2761 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX 2762 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2763 * the ack TX timestamp. 2764 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in 2765 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2766 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2767 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX 2768 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2769 * the incoming frame RX timestamp. 2770 * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent 2771 * (re)associations. 2772 * 2773 * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest 2774 * bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1 2775 * indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are 2776 * reserved. 2777 * 2778 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available 2779 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined 2780 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2781 */ 2782 enum nl80211_attrs { 2783 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 2784 NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC, 2785 2786 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, 2787 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 2788 2789 NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 2790 NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME, 2791 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, 2792 2793 NL80211_ATTR_MAC, 2794 2795 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 2796 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, 2797 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 2798 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ, 2799 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 2800 2801 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 2802 NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, 2803 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD, 2804 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL, 2805 2806 NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID, 2807 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS, 2808 NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL, 2809 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES, 2810 NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN, 2811 NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO, 2812 2813 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS, 2814 2815 NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS, 2816 2817 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID, 2818 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION, 2819 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP, 2820 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO, 2821 2822 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT, 2823 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2824 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 2825 2826 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY, 2827 2828 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES, 2829 2830 NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2, 2831 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES, 2832 2833 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG, 2834 2835 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES, 2836 2837 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, 2838 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 2839 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE, 2840 2841 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 2842 2843 NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE, 2844 NL80211_ATTR_IE, 2845 2846 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS, 2847 2848 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 2849 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS, 2850 NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */ 2851 NL80211_ATTR_BSS, 2852 2853 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR, 2854 NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE, 2855 2856 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS, 2857 2858 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME, 2859 NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 2860 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 2861 NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE, 2862 2863 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE, 2864 2865 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2866 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES, 2867 2868 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE, 2869 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER, 2870 2871 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED, 2872 2873 2874 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, 2875 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 2876 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, 2877 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD, 2878 2879 NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT, 2880 2881 NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, 2882 2883 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2, 2884 2885 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 2886 2887 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 2888 2889 NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 2890 2891 NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP, 2892 NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE, 2893 2894 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE, 2895 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, 2896 NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 2897 NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, 2898 2899 NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE, 2900 NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE, 2901 2902 NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID, 2903 2904 NL80211_ATTR_KEY, 2905 NL80211_ATTR_KEYS, 2906 2907 NL80211_ATTR_PID, 2908 2909 NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR, 2910 2911 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO, 2912 2913 NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, 2914 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS, 2915 2916 NL80211_ATTR_DURATION, 2917 2918 NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE, 2919 2920 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS, 2921 2922 NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES, 2923 2924 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH, 2925 2926 NL80211_ATTR_ACK, 2927 2928 NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE, 2929 2930 NL80211_ATTR_CQM, 2931 2932 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE, 2933 2934 NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE, 2935 2936 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING, 2937 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL, 2938 2939 NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES, 2940 NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES, 2941 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE, 2942 2943 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 2944 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 2945 2946 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN, 2947 2948 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX, 2949 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX, 2950 2951 NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE, 2952 2953 NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK, 2954 2955 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE, 2956 2957 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 2958 2959 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION, 2960 2961 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP, 2962 2963 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX, 2964 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX, 2965 2966 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH, 2967 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE, 2968 2969 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS, 2970 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, 2971 2972 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL, 2973 2974 NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS, 2975 NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES, 2976 2977 NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA, 2978 2979 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS, 2980 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2981 2982 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES, 2983 2984 NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, 2985 2986 NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP, 2987 NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP, 2988 2989 NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME, 2990 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD, 2991 2992 NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT, 2993 2994 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, 2995 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS, 2996 2997 NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 2998 2999 NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE, 3000 3001 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION, 3002 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN, 3003 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION, 3004 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT, 3005 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP, 3006 3007 NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME, 3008 3009 NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK, 3010 3011 NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS, 3012 3013 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD, 3014 3015 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP, 3016 3017 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION, 3018 3019 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT, 3020 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3021 3022 NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP, 3023 3024 NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 3025 3026 NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM, 3027 3028 NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 3029 3030 NL80211_ATTR_WDEV, 3031 3032 NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE, 3033 3034 NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON, 3035 3036 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA, 3037 3038 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY, 3039 3040 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS, 3041 3042 NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH, 3043 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1, 3044 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2, 3045 3046 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW, 3047 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS, 3048 3049 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE, 3050 3051 NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY, 3052 3053 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS, 3054 3055 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX, 3056 3057 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT, 3058 3059 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 3060 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, 3061 3062 NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY, 3063 NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY, 3064 3065 NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 3066 NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP, 3067 3068 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT, 3069 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3070 3071 NL80211_ATTR_MDID, 3072 NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC, 3073 3074 NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID, 3075 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION, 3076 3077 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID, 3078 3079 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 3080 3081 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT, 3082 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX, 3083 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES, 3084 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON, 3085 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP, 3086 3087 NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS, 3088 3089 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS, 3090 3091 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES, 3092 3093 NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS, 3094 3095 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ, 3096 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ, 3097 3098 NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF, 3099 3100 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID, 3101 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD, 3102 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 3103 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS, 3104 3105 NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP, 3106 3107 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, 3108 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT, 3109 3110 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA, 3111 3112 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY, 3113 3114 NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER, 3115 3116 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX, 3117 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS, 3118 3119 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR, 3120 3121 NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM, 3122 3123 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK, 3124 3125 NL80211_ATTR_TSID, 3126 NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO, 3127 NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME, 3128 3129 NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 3130 3131 NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS, 3132 3133 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK, 3134 3135 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG, 3136 3137 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES, 3138 3139 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS, 3140 3141 NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD, 3142 3143 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY, 3144 3145 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR, 3146 3147 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3148 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 3149 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 3150 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3151 3152 NL80211_ATTR_PBSS, 3153 3154 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT, 3155 3156 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS, 3157 3158 NL80211_ATTR_PAD, 3159 3160 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA, 3161 3162 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA, 3163 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR, 3164 3165 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF, 3166 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID, 3167 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION, 3168 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY, 3169 3170 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID, 3171 3172 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 3173 NL80211_ATTR_BANDS, 3174 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC, 3175 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH, 3176 3177 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK, 3178 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES, 3179 3180 NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED, 3181 3182 NL80211_ATTR_BSSID, 3183 3184 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 3185 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST, 3186 3187 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON, 3188 3189 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME, 3190 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM, 3191 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM, 3192 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK, 3193 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 3194 3195 NL80211_ATTR_PMK, 3196 3197 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI, 3198 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS, 3199 3200 NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS, 3201 NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME, 3202 NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 3203 3204 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION, 3205 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT, 3206 3207 NL80211_ATTR_NSS, 3208 NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL, 3209 3210 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 3211 3212 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS, 3213 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT, 3214 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT, 3215 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM, 3216 3217 NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY, 3218 3219 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER, 3220 3221 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 3222 3223 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT, 3224 3225 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS, 3226 3227 NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3228 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING, 3229 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER, 3230 3231 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD, 3232 3233 NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER, 3234 3235 NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD, 3236 3237 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS, 3238 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 3239 3240 NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID, 3241 3242 NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR, 3243 3244 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES, 3245 3246 NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG, 3247 3248 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 3249 3250 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME, 3251 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD, 3252 3253 NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST, 3254 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, 3255 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET, 3256 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 3257 3258 NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY, 3259 3260 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY, 3261 3262 NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 3263 3264 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY, 3265 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3266 3267 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE, 3268 3269 NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED, 3270 3271 NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC, 3272 3273 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE, 3274 3275 NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 3276 3277 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT, 3278 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR, 3279 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS, 3280 3281 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, 3282 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 3283 3284 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 3285 3286 NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS, 3287 3288 NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY, 3289 3290 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT, 3291 3292 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS, 3293 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID, 3294 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR, 3295 3296 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT, 3297 3298 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES, 3299 3300 NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY, 3301 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS, 3302 3303 NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3304 NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3305 NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP, 3306 3307 NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP, 3308 3309 /* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */ 3310 3311 __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3312 NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3313 NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3314 }; 3315 3316 /* source-level API compatibility */ 3317 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION 3318 #define NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG 3319 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 3320 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA 3321 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON 3322 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP 3323 3324 /* 3325 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them 3326 * here 3327 */ 3328 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 3329 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY 3330 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES 3331 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS 3332 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 3333 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE 3334 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE 3335 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE 3336 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR 3337 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE 3338 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 3339 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID 3340 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE 3341 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE 3342 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE 3343 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP 3344 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS 3345 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES 3346 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY 3347 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS 3348 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 3349 3350 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN 64 3351 3352 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES 32 3353 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES 77 3354 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES 128 3355 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY 0 3356 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY 16 3357 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY 24 3358 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN 26 3359 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN 12 3360 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 16 3361 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 54 3362 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES 5 3363 3364 /* 3365 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 3366 * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. 3367 */ 3368 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES 2 3369 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 13 3370 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 51 3371 3372 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME 10 3373 3374 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */ 3375 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF -300 3376 3377 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL 1800 3378 3379 /** 3380 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types 3381 * 3382 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides 3383 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member 3384 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member 3385 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point 3386 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces 3387 * are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing 3388 * AP type interface. 3389 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface 3390 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames 3391 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point 3392 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client 3393 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner 3394 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev 3395 * and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the 3396 * %NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE 3397 * commands to create and destroy one 3398 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS 3399 * This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true 3400 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev) 3401 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined 3402 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types 3403 * 3404 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE 3405 * to set the type of an interface. 3406 * 3407 */ 3408 enum nl80211_iftype { 3409 NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED, 3410 NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC, 3411 NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION, 3412 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP, 3413 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN, 3414 NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS, 3415 NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR, 3416 NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT, 3417 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT, 3418 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO, 3419 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE, 3420 NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB, 3421 NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN, 3422 3423 /* keep last */ 3424 NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES, 3425 NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1 3426 }; 3427 3428 /** 3429 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags 3430 * 3431 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is 3432 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.) 3433 * 3434 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3435 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 3436 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames 3437 * with short barker preamble 3438 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable 3439 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection 3440 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated 3441 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should 3442 * only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the 3443 * flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and 3444 * attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected 3445 * as errors.) 3446 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers 3447 * that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a 3448 * previously added station into associated state 3449 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined 3450 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3451 */ 3452 enum nl80211_sta_flags { 3453 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID, 3454 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, 3455 NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3456 NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME, 3457 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP, 3458 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED, 3459 NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER, 3460 NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED, 3461 3462 /* keep last */ 3463 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 3464 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 3465 }; 3466 3467 /** 3468 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS 3469 * 3470 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism 3471 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism 3472 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values 3473 */ 3474 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status { 3475 NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0, 3476 NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED, 3477 3478 NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS, 3479 }; 3480 3481 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER 3482 3483 /** 3484 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set 3485 * @mask: mask of station flags to set 3486 * @set: which values to set them to 3487 * 3488 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags. 3489 */ 3490 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update { 3491 __u32 mask; 3492 __u32 set; 3493 } __attribute__((packed)); 3494 3495 /** 3496 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval 3497 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3498 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3499 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3500 */ 3501 enum nl80211_he_gi { 3502 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8, 3503 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6, 3504 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2, 3505 }; 3506 3507 /** 3508 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field 3509 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec 3510 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec 3511 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec 3512 */ 3513 enum nl80211_he_ltf { 3514 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF, 3515 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF, 3516 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF, 3517 }; 3518 3519 /** 3520 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values 3521 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3522 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3523 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3524 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3525 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3526 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3527 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3528 */ 3529 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc { 3530 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26, 3531 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52, 3532 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106, 3533 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242, 3534 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484, 3535 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996, 3536 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3537 }; 3538 3539 /** 3540 * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval 3541 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3542 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3543 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3544 */ 3545 enum nl80211_eht_gi { 3546 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8, 3547 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6, 3548 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2, 3549 }; 3550 3551 /** 3552 * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values 3553 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3554 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3555 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation 3556 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3557 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation 3558 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3559 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3560 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation 3561 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3562 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation 3563 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation 3564 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3565 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation 3566 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation 3567 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation 3568 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation 3569 */ 3570 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc { 3571 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26, 3572 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52, 3573 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26, 3574 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106, 3575 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26, 3576 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242, 3577 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484, 3578 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242, 3579 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996, 3580 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484, 3581 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242, 3582 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3583 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484, 3584 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996, 3585 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484, 3586 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996, 3587 }; 3588 3589 /** 3590 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information 3591 * 3592 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE 3593 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3594 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents 3595 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value. 3596 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported 3597 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits 3598 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included. 3599 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall 3600 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels. 3601 * 3602 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3603 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s) 3604 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8) 3605 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate 3606 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 3607 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s) 3608 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined 3609 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8) 3610 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8) 3611 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate 3612 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the 3613 * same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates 3614 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate 3615 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is 3616 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3617 * half the base (20 MHz) rate 3618 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is 3619 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3620 * a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate 3621 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11) 3622 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3623 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier 3624 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi) 3625 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1) 3626 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then 3627 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc) 3628 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate 3629 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15) 3630 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3631 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier 3632 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 3633 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then 3634 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc) 3635 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3636 */ 3637 enum nl80211_rate_info { 3638 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID, 3639 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE, 3640 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS, 3641 NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH, 3642 NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI, 3643 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32, 3644 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS, 3645 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS, 3646 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3647 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3648 NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH, 3649 NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH, 3650 NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH, 3651 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS, 3652 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS, 3653 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI, 3654 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM, 3655 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC, 3656 NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH, 3657 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS, 3658 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS, 3659 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI, 3660 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC, 3661 3662 /* keep last */ 3663 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3664 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3665 }; 3666 3667 /** 3668 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA 3669 * 3670 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM 3671 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3672 * 3673 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3674 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag) 3675 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 3676 * (flag) 3677 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 3678 * (flag) 3679 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8) 3680 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16) 3681 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined 3682 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3683 */ 3684 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param { 3685 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID, 3686 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT, 3687 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3688 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 3689 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD, 3690 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL, 3691 3692 /* keep last */ 3693 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST, 3694 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1 3695 }; 3696 3697 /** 3698 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information 3699 * 3700 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO 3701 * when getting information about a station. 3702 * 3703 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3704 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs) 3705 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3706 * (u32, from this station) 3707 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3708 * (u32, to this station) 3709 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3710 * (u64, from this station) 3711 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3712 * (u64, to this station) 3713 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm) 3714 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute 3715 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info 3716 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3717 * (u32, from this station) 3718 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3719 * (u32, to this station) 3720 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station) 3721 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs) 3722 * (u32, to this station) 3723 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm) 3724 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID 3725 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID 3726 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station 3727 * (see %enum nl80211_plink_state) 3728 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested 3729 * attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE. 3730 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute 3731 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param 3732 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected 3733 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 3734 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32) 3735 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64) 3736 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 3737 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode 3738 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards 3739 * non-peer STA 3740 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU 3741 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm) 3742 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average 3743 * Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL. 3744 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the 3745 * 802.11 header (u32, kbps) 3746 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons 3747 * (u64) 3748 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64) 3749 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average 3750 * for beacons only (u8, dBm) 3751 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats) 3752 * This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the 3753 * TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames; 3754 * each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats 3755 * attributes carrying the actual values. 3756 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3757 * received from the station (u64, usec) 3758 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3759 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm) 3760 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm) 3761 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs) 3762 * (u32, from this station) 3763 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received 3764 * with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include 3765 * some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter 3766 * might not be fully accurate. 3767 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a 3768 * mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1) 3769 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3770 * sent to the station (u64, usec) 3771 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16) 3772 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station 3773 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds) 3774 * of STA's association 3775 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a 3776 * authentication server (u8, 0 or 1) 3777 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal 3778 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute 3779 */ 3780 enum nl80211_sta_info { 3781 __NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID, 3782 NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME, 3783 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES, 3784 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES, 3785 NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID, 3786 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID, 3787 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE, 3788 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL, 3789 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE, 3790 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS, 3791 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS, 3792 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES, 3793 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED, 3794 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG, 3795 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE, 3796 NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM, 3797 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME, 3798 NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS, 3799 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS, 3800 NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET, 3801 NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM, 3802 NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM, 3803 NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM, 3804 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64, 3805 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64, 3806 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 3807 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG, 3808 NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT, 3809 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC, 3810 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX, 3811 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG, 3812 NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS, 3813 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION, 3814 NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD, 3815 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL, 3816 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG, 3817 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS, 3818 NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT, 3819 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 3820 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION, 3821 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3822 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC, 3823 NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME, 3824 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 3825 3826 /* keep last */ 3827 __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3828 NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3829 }; 3830 3831 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 3832 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG 3833 3834 3835 /** 3836 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes 3837 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3838 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64) 3839 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or 3840 * attempted to transmit; u64) 3841 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for 3842 * transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64) 3843 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted 3844 * MSDUs (u64) 3845 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3846 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute) 3847 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here 3848 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3849 */ 3850 enum nl80211_tid_stats { 3851 __NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID, 3852 NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU, 3853 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU, 3854 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES, 3855 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED, 3856 NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD, 3857 NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS, 3858 3859 /* keep last */ 3860 NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS, 3861 NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1 3862 }; 3863 3864 /** 3865 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes 3866 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3867 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here 3868 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged 3869 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently 3870 * backlogged 3871 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen 3872 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops 3873 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks 3874 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow 3875 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 3876 * (only for per-phy stats) 3877 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions 3878 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ 3879 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ 3880 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY 3881 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3882 */ 3883 enum nl80211_txq_stats { 3884 __NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID, 3885 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES, 3886 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS, 3887 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS, 3888 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS, 3889 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS, 3890 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT, 3891 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY, 3892 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS, 3893 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES, 3894 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS, 3895 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS, 3896 3897 /* keep last */ 3898 NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS, 3899 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1 3900 }; 3901 3902 /** 3903 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags 3904 * 3905 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active 3906 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running 3907 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN 3908 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set 3909 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded 3910 */ 3911 enum nl80211_mpath_flags { 3912 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<0, 3913 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING = 1<<1, 3914 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID = 1<<2, 3915 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED = 1<<3, 3916 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED = 1<<4, 3917 }; 3918 3919 /** 3920 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information 3921 * 3922 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting 3923 * information about a mesh path. 3924 * 3925 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3926 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination 3927 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number 3928 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path 3929 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now 3930 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in 3931 * &enum nl80211_mpath_flags; 3932 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec 3933 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries 3934 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination 3935 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination 3936 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number 3937 * currently defined 3938 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3939 */ 3940 enum nl80211_mpath_info { 3941 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID, 3942 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN, 3943 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN, 3944 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC, 3945 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME, 3946 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS, 3947 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 3948 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES, 3949 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT, 3950 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE, 3951 3952 /* keep last */ 3953 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3954 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3955 }; 3956 3957 /** 3958 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes 3959 * 3960 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3961 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute 3962 * for each interface type that supports the band data 3963 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE 3964 * capabilities IE 3965 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE 3966 * capabilities IE 3967 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE 3968 * capabilities IE 3969 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as 3970 * defined in HE capabilities IE 3971 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16), 3972 * given for all 6 GHz band channels 3973 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are 3974 * advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary) 3975 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT 3976 * capabilities element 3977 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT 3978 * capabilities element 3979 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT 3980 * capabilities element 3981 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as 3982 * defined in EHT capabilities element 3983 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3984 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 3985 */ 3986 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr { 3987 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID, 3988 3989 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES, 3990 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC, 3991 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY, 3992 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET, 3993 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE, 3994 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA, 3995 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS, 3996 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC, 3997 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY, 3998 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET, 3999 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE, 4000 4001 /* keep last */ 4002 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4003 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4004 }; 4005 4006 /** 4007 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes 4008 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4009 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band, 4010 * an array of nested frequency attributes 4011 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band, 4012 * an array of nested bitrate attributes 4013 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4014 * defined in 802.11n 4015 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4016 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n 4017 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n 4018 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4019 * defined in 802.11ac 4020 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4021 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using 4022 * attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr 4023 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 4024 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 4025 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. 4026 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 4027 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. 4028 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 4029 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 4030 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4031 */ 4032 enum nl80211_band_attr { 4033 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID, 4034 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS, 4035 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES, 4036 4037 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET, 4038 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA, 4039 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR, 4040 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY, 4041 4042 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET, 4043 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA, 4044 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA, 4045 4046 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS, 4047 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 4048 4049 /* keep last */ 4050 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4051 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4052 }; 4053 4054 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA 4055 4056 /** 4057 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule 4058 * 4059 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4060 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot. 4061 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot. 4062 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space. 4063 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time. 4064 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule. 4065 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use. 4066 */ 4067 enum nl80211_wmm_rule { 4068 __NL80211_WMMR_INVALID, 4069 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN, 4070 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX, 4071 NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN, 4072 NL80211_WMMR_TXOP, 4073 4074 /* keep last */ 4075 __NL80211_WMMR_LAST, 4076 NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1 4077 }; 4078 4079 /** 4080 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes 4081 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4082 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz 4083 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current 4084 * regulatory domain. 4085 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation 4086 * are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe 4087 * requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing. 4088 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory 4089 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4090 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm 4091 * (100 * dBm). 4092 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS 4093 * (enum nl80211_dfs_state) 4094 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long 4095 * this channel is in this DFS state. 4096 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this 4097 * channel as the control channel 4098 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this 4099 * channel as the control channel 4100 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel 4101 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible, 4102 * this includes 80+80 channels 4103 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel 4104 * using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels 4105 * isn't possible 4106 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4107 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this 4108 * channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be 4109 * used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in 4110 * an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not 4111 * through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master 4112 * that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power. 4113 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this 4114 * channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on 4115 * the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz 4116 * band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS 4117 * off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be 4118 * done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under 4119 * the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS 4120 * off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and 4121 * radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e., 4122 * wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this 4123 * attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP). 4124 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed 4125 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4126 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed 4127 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4128 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations. 4129 * This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC. 4130 * (see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule) 4131 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel 4132 * in current regulatory domain. 4133 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 4134 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed 4135 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4136 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed 4137 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4138 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed 4139 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4140 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed 4141 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4142 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed 4143 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4144 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel 4145 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible 4146 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel 4147 * in current regulatory domain. 4148 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number 4149 * currently defined 4150 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4151 * 4152 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122 4153 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed 4154 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and 4155 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT. 4156 */ 4157 enum nl80211_frequency_attr { 4158 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID, 4159 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ, 4160 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED, 4161 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR, 4162 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS, 4163 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR, 4164 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER, 4165 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE, 4166 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME, 4167 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS, 4168 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS, 4169 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ, 4170 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ, 4171 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4172 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY, 4173 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT, 4174 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ, 4175 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ, 4176 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM, 4177 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE, 4178 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET, 4179 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ, 4180 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ, 4181 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ, 4182 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ, 4183 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ, 4184 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ, 4185 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT, 4186 4187 /* keep last */ 4188 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4189 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4190 }; 4191 4192 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER 4193 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4194 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4195 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4196 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \ 4197 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4198 4199 /** 4200 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes 4201 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4202 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps 4203 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported 4204 * in 2.4 GHz band. 4205 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number 4206 * currently defined 4207 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4208 */ 4209 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr { 4210 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID, 4211 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE, 4212 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE, 4213 4214 /* keep last */ 4215 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4216 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4217 }; 4218 4219 /** 4220 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request 4221 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world 4222 * regulatory domain. 4223 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the 4224 * regulatory domain. 4225 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the 4226 * wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in. 4227 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an 4228 * 802.11 country information element with regulatory information it 4229 * thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country 4230 * code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information 4231 * structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb. 4232 * If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should 4233 * be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation. 4234 */ 4235 enum nl80211_reg_initiator { 4236 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE, 4237 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER, 4238 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, 4239 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE, 4240 }; 4241 4242 /** 4243 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain 4244 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains 4245 * to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the 4246 * ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid. 4247 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory 4248 * domain. 4249 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom 4250 * driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide 4251 * and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested 4252 * them to be applied. 4253 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product 4254 * of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously 4255 * set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory 4256 * domain request to be processed. 4257 */ 4258 enum nl80211_reg_type { 4259 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY, 4260 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD, 4261 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD, 4262 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION, 4263 }; 4264 4265 /** 4266 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes 4267 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4268 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional 4269 * considerations for a given frequency range. These are the 4270 * &enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags. 4271 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory 4272 * rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory 4273 * band edge. 4274 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule 4275 * in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory 4276 * band edge. 4277 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this 4278 * frequency range, in KHz. 4279 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain 4280 * for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi). 4281 * If you don't have one then don't send this. 4282 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for 4283 * a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm). 4284 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4285 * If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used. 4286 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number 4287 * currently defined 4288 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4289 */ 4290 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr { 4291 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID, 4292 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, 4293 4294 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START, 4295 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END, 4296 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW, 4297 4298 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN, 4299 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP, 4300 4301 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4302 4303 /* keep last */ 4304 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4305 NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4306 }; 4307 4308 /** 4309 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes 4310 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4311 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching, 4312 * only report BSS with matching SSID. 4313 * (This cannot be used together with BSSID.) 4314 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a 4315 * BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that 4316 * if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as 4317 * the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a 4318 * matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with 4319 * how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem, 4320 * the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this 4321 * attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute. 4322 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether 4323 * %NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or 4324 * relative to current bss's RSSI. 4325 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 4326 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 4327 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 4328 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 4329 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching 4330 * (this cannot be used together with SSID). 4331 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the 4332 * band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in 4333 * enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a 4334 * band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one 4335 * of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the 4336 * minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated 4337 * within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such 4338 * attributes will be nested within this attribute. 4339 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter 4340 * attribute number currently defined 4341 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4342 */ 4343 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr { 4344 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID, 4345 4346 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID, 4347 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI, 4348 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI, 4349 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 4350 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID, 4351 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, 4352 4353 /* keep last */ 4354 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4355 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = 4356 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4357 }; 4358 4359 /* only for backward compatibility */ 4360 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID 4361 4362 /** 4363 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags 4364 * 4365 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed 4366 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed 4367 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed 4368 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed 4369 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used 4370 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links 4371 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links 4372 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed, 4373 * this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require 4374 * beaconing. 4375 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated 4376 * base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross 4377 * multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges. 4378 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4379 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation 4380 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation 4381 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed 4382 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed 4383 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed 4384 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed 4385 */ 4386 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags { 4387 NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM = 1<<0, 4388 NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK = 1<<1, 4389 NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR = 1<<2, 4390 NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR = 1<<3, 4391 NL80211_RRF_DFS = 1<<4, 4392 NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY = 1<<5, 4393 NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY = 1<<6, 4394 NL80211_RRF_NO_IR = 1<<7, 4395 __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS = 1<<8, 4396 NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW = 1<<11, 4397 NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<12, 4398 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<13, 4399 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<14, 4400 NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ = 1<<15, 4401 NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ = 1<<16, 4402 NL80211_RRF_NO_HE = 1<<17, 4403 NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ = 1<<18, 4404 }; 4405 4406 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4407 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4408 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4409 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40 (NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\ 4410 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS) 4411 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT 4412 4413 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */ 4414 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL (NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS) 4415 4416 /** 4417 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions 4418 * 4419 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified 4420 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC 4421 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI 4422 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec 4423 */ 4424 enum nl80211_dfs_regions { 4425 NL80211_DFS_UNSET = 0, 4426 NL80211_DFS_FCC = 1, 4427 NL80211_DFS_ETSI = 2, 4428 NL80211_DFS_JP = 3, 4429 }; 4430 4431 /** 4432 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint 4433 * 4434 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always 4435 * assumed if the attribute is not set. 4436 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular 4437 * base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work 4438 * properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints 4439 * by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature 4440 * capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will 4441 * ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device 4442 * present has been registered with the wireless core that 4443 * has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a 4444 * supported feature. 4445 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the 4446 * platform is operating in an indoor environment. 4447 */ 4448 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type { 4449 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER = 0, 4450 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1, 4451 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR = 2, 4452 }; 4453 4454 /** 4455 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information 4456 * 4457 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO 4458 * when getting information about a survey. 4459 * 4460 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4461 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel 4462 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm) 4463 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 4464 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio 4465 * was turned on (on channel or globally) 4466 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary 4467 * channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect) 4468 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension 4469 * channel was sensed busy 4470 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4471 * receiving data (on channel or globally) 4472 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent 4473 * transmitting data (on channel or globally) 4474 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan 4475 * (on this channel or globally) 4476 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 4477 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4478 * receiving frames destined to the local BSS 4479 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number 4480 * currently defined 4481 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz 4482 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4483 */ 4484 enum nl80211_survey_info { 4485 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID, 4486 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY, 4487 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE, 4488 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE, 4489 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME, 4490 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY, 4491 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY, 4492 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX, 4493 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX, 4494 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN, 4495 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD, 4496 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX, 4497 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 4498 4499 /* keep last */ 4500 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 4501 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 4502 }; 4503 4504 /* keep old names for compatibility */ 4505 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME 4506 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY 4507 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY 4508 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX 4509 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX 4510 4511 /** 4512 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags 4513 * 4514 * Monitor configuration flags. 4515 * 4516 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved 4517 * 4518 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 4519 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 4520 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 4521 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 4522 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing. 4523 * overrides all other flags. 4524 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address 4525 * and ACK incoming unicast packets. 4526 * 4527 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4528 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag 4529 */ 4530 enum nl80211_mntr_flags { 4531 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 4532 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 4533 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 4534 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 4535 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 4536 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 4537 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 4538 4539 /* keep last */ 4540 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 4541 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 4542 }; 4543 4544 /** 4545 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes 4546 * 4547 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is 4548 * not known or has not been set yet. 4549 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is 4550 * in Awake state all the time. 4551 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4552 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for 4553 * neighbor's beacons. 4554 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4555 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up 4556 * for neighbor's beacons. 4557 * 4558 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use 4559 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level 4560 */ 4561 4562 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode { 4563 NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN, 4564 NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE, 4565 NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP, 4566 NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP, 4567 4568 __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST, 4569 NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1 4570 }; 4571 4572 /** 4573 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters 4574 * 4575 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is 4576 * active. 4577 * 4578 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use 4579 * 4580 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in 4581 * millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message 4582 * 4583 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in 4584 * millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link 4585 * 4586 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in 4587 * millisecond units 4588 * 4589 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed 4590 * on this mesh interface 4591 * 4592 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link 4593 * open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a 4594 * mesh 4595 * 4596 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh 4597 * point. 4598 * 4599 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open 4600 * peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if 4601 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are 4602 * set. 4603 * 4604 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames 4605 * containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path 4606 * target) 4607 * 4608 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths 4609 * (in milliseconds) 4610 * 4611 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait 4612 * until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds) 4613 * 4614 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh 4615 * points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from 4616 * the root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 4617 * 4618 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4619 * TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 4620 * reference element 4621 * 4622 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs) 4623 * that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the 4624 * mesh 4625 * 4626 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not 4627 * 4628 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a 4629 * source mesh point for path selection elements. 4630 * 4631 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4632 * root announcements are transmitted. 4633 * 4634 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has 4635 * access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. This is done via Root 4636 * Announcement frames. 4637 * 4638 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4639 * TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a 4640 * PERR element. 4641 * 4642 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding 4643 * or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 4644 * 4645 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the 4646 * threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish 4647 * a peer link. 4648 * 4649 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors 4650 * to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 4651 * (see 11C.12.2.2) 4652 * 4653 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode. 4654 * 4655 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute 4656 * 4657 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for 4658 * which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding 4659 * information to the root mesh STA to be valid. 4660 * 4661 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4662 * proactive PREQs are transmitted. 4663 * 4664 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time 4665 * (in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame 4666 * containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 4667 * 4668 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links. 4669 * type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32) 4670 * 4671 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs) 4672 * 4673 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've 4674 * established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then 4675 * remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable 4676 * the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes. 4677 * 4678 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA 4679 * will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation 4680 * field. If left unset then the mesh formation field will only 4681 * advertise such if there is an active root mesh path. 4682 * 4683 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. 4684 * PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that 4685 * this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be 4686 * better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 4687 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 4688 * 4689 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA 4690 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 4691 * in the mesh formation field. 4692 * 4693 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4694 */ 4695 enum nl80211_meshconf_params { 4696 __NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID, 4697 NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT, 4698 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT, 4699 NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT, 4700 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS, 4701 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES, 4702 NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL, 4703 NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS, 4704 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES, 4705 NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME, 4706 NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 4707 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT, 4708 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL, 4709 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME, 4710 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE, 4711 NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL, 4712 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL, 4713 NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS, 4714 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL, 4715 NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING, 4716 NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD, 4717 NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR, 4718 NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE, 4719 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT, 4720 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL, 4721 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL, 4722 NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE, 4723 NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW, 4724 NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT, 4725 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 4726 NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN, 4727 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 4728 4729 /* keep last */ 4730 __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4731 NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4732 }; 4733 4734 /** 4735 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters 4736 * 4737 * Mesh setup parameters. These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be 4738 * changed while the mesh is active. 4739 * 4740 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use 4741 * 4742 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a 4743 * vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the 4744 * default HWMP. 4745 * 4746 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a 4747 * vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime 4748 * metric. 4749 * 4750 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a 4751 * robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element 4752 * that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and 4753 * metrics in use. 4754 * 4755 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication 4756 * daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates. 4757 * 4758 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication 4759 * daemon will be securing peer link frames. AMPE is a secured version of 4760 * Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of 4761 * a userspace daemon. When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer 4762 * management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE 4763 * functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and 4764 * key management). When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can 4765 * autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a 4766 * userspace daemon. 4767 * 4768 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a 4769 * vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default 4770 * neighbor offset synchronization 4771 * 4772 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will 4773 * implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state. 4774 * 4775 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication 4776 * method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE). 4777 * Default is no authentication method required. 4778 * 4779 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number 4780 * 4781 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use 4782 */ 4783 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params { 4784 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID, 4785 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL, 4786 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC, 4787 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE, 4788 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 4789 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, 4790 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC, 4791 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM, 4792 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL, 4793 4794 /* keep last */ 4795 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4796 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4797 }; 4798 4799 /** 4800 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes 4801 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved 4802 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*) 4803 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning 4804 * disabled 4805 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 4806 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4807 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 4808 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4809 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 4810 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 4811 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number 4812 */ 4813 enum nl80211_txq_attr { 4814 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID, 4815 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC, 4816 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP, 4817 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN, 4818 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX, 4819 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS, 4820 4821 /* keep last */ 4822 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4823 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4824 }; 4825 4826 enum nl80211_ac { 4827 NL80211_AC_VO, 4828 NL80211_AC_VI, 4829 NL80211_AC_BE, 4830 NL80211_AC_BK, 4831 NL80211_NUM_ACS 4832 }; 4833 4834 /* backward compat */ 4835 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC 4836 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO NL80211_AC_VO 4837 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI NL80211_AC_VI 4838 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE NL80211_AC_BE 4839 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK NL80211_AC_BK 4840 4841 /** 4842 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type 4843 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4844 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel 4845 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4846 * below the control channel 4847 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4848 * above the control channel 4849 */ 4850 enum nl80211_channel_type { 4851 NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT, 4852 NL80211_CHAN_HT20, 4853 NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS, 4854 NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS 4855 }; 4856 4857 /** 4858 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode 4859 * 4860 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default) 4861 * Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately 4862 * 4863 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the 4864 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: 4865 * 4866 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: 4867 * Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet 4868 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: 4869 * The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes 4870 * the preferred Tx key for the station. 4871 */ 4872 enum nl80211_key_mode { 4873 NL80211_KEY_RX_TX, 4874 NL80211_KEY_NO_TX, 4875 NL80211_KEY_SET_TX 4876 }; 4877 4878 /** 4879 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions 4880 * 4881 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH 4882 * attribute. 4883 * 4884 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4885 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel 4886 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4887 * attribute must be provided as well 4888 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4889 * attribute must be provided as well 4890 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4891 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well 4892 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4893 * attribute must be provided as well 4894 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel 4895 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel 4896 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel 4897 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel 4898 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel 4899 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel 4900 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel 4901 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4902 * attribute must be provided as well 4903 */ 4904 enum nl80211_chan_width { 4905 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT, 4906 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 4907 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40, 4908 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80, 4909 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80, 4910 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160, 4911 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 4912 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 4913 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 4914 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 4915 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4, 4916 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8, 4917 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16, 4918 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320, 4919 }; 4920 4921 /** 4922 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS 4923 * 4924 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute. 4925 * 4926 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible 4927 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide 4928 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide 4929 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide 4930 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide 4931 */ 4932 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width { 4933 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 4934 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 4935 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 4936 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 4937 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 4938 }; 4939 4940 /** 4941 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS 4942 * 4943 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid 4944 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets) 4945 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32) 4946 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64) 4947 * (if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be 4948 * from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon 4949 * that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from) 4950 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16) 4951 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16) 4952 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the 4953 * raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin); 4954 * if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is 4955 * different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise 4956 * they are from a Beacon frame. 4957 * However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these 4958 * IEs may be from either frame subtype. 4959 * If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the 4960 * data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics. 4961 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon 4962 * in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32) 4963 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon 4964 * in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8) 4965 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used" 4966 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms 4967 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information 4968 * elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has 4969 * yet been received 4970 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel 4971 * (u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) 4972 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64) 4973 * (not present if no beacon frame has been received yet) 4974 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and 4975 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute) 4976 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry 4977 * was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be 4978 * accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 4979 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 4980 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first 4981 * octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for 4982 * this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by 4983 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64). 4984 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF 4985 * is set. 4986 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update. 4987 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm), 4988 * using the nesting index as the antenna number. 4989 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 4990 * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8). 4991 * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it. 4992 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal 4993 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute 4994 */ 4995 enum nl80211_bss { 4996 __NL80211_BSS_INVALID, 4997 NL80211_BSS_BSSID, 4998 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY, 4999 NL80211_BSS_TSF, 5000 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL, 5001 NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY, 5002 NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS, 5003 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM, 5004 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 5005 NL80211_BSS_STATUS, 5006 NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO, 5007 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES, 5008 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH, 5009 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF, 5010 NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA, 5011 NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME, 5012 NL80211_BSS_PAD, 5013 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 5014 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID, 5015 NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 5016 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 5017 NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID, 5018 NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR, 5019 5020 /* keep last */ 5021 __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST, 5022 NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1 5023 }; 5024 5025 /** 5026 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status" 5027 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS. 5028 * Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer 5029 * keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with 5030 * a given BSS. 5031 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS. 5032 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS. 5033 * 5034 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which 5035 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS. 5036 */ 5037 enum nl80211_bss_status { 5038 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED, 5039 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED, 5040 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED, 5041 }; 5042 5043 /** 5044 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType 5045 * 5046 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication 5047 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only) 5048 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r) 5049 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP) 5050 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals 5051 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key 5052 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS 5053 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key 5054 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal 5055 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm 5056 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by 5057 * trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out 5058 * the attribute for this on CONNECT commands. 5059 */ 5060 enum nl80211_auth_type { 5061 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM, 5062 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY, 5063 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT, 5064 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP, 5065 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE, 5066 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK, 5067 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS, 5068 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK, 5069 5070 /* keep last */ 5071 __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM, 5072 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1, 5073 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC 5074 }; 5075 5076 /** 5077 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type 5078 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key 5079 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key 5080 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS) 5081 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types 5082 */ 5083 enum nl80211_key_type { 5084 NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP, 5085 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE, 5086 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY, 5087 5088 NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES 5089 }; 5090 5091 /** 5092 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state 5093 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used 5094 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required 5095 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional 5096 */ 5097 enum nl80211_mfp { 5098 NL80211_MFP_NO, 5099 NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED, 5100 NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL, 5101 }; 5102 5103 enum nl80211_wpa_versions { 5104 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0, 5105 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1, 5106 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2, 5107 }; 5108 5109 /** 5110 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types 5111 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid 5112 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default 5113 * unicast key 5114 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default 5115 * multicast key 5116 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types 5117 */ 5118 enum nl80211_key_default_types { 5119 __NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID, 5120 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST, 5121 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST, 5122 5123 NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES 5124 }; 5125 5126 /** 5127 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes 5128 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid 5129 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 5130 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 5131 * keys 5132 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 5133 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 5134 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 5135 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 5136 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 5137 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key 5138 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key 5139 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not 5140 * specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was 5141 * given with the command using the key or not (u32) 5142 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 5143 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 5144 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 5145 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode. 5146 * Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX. 5147 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key 5148 * 5149 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal 5150 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute 5151 */ 5152 enum nl80211_key_attributes { 5153 __NL80211_KEY_INVALID, 5154 NL80211_KEY_DATA, 5155 NL80211_KEY_IDX, 5156 NL80211_KEY_CIPHER, 5157 NL80211_KEY_SEQ, 5158 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT, 5159 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 5160 NL80211_KEY_TYPE, 5161 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 5162 NL80211_KEY_MODE, 5163 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON, 5164 5165 /* keep last */ 5166 __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST, 5167 NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1 5168 }; 5169 5170 /** 5171 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes 5172 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid 5173 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5174 * in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with 5175 * 1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most 5176 * %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array). 5177 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5178 * in an array of MCS numbers. 5179 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5180 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht 5181 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi 5182 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5183 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_he 5184 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us. 5185 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF. 5186 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal 5187 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute 5188 */ 5189 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes { 5190 __NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID, 5191 NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY, 5192 NL80211_TXRATE_HT, 5193 NL80211_TXRATE_VHT, 5194 NL80211_TXRATE_GI, 5195 NL80211_TXRATE_HE, 5196 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI, 5197 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF, 5198 5199 /* keep last */ 5200 __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST, 5201 NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1 5202 }; 5203 5204 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT 5205 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX 8 5206 5207 /** 5208 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5209 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5210 */ 5211 struct nl80211_txrate_vht { 5212 __u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 5213 }; 5214 5215 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX 8 5216 /** 5217 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5218 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5219 */ 5220 struct nl80211_txrate_he { 5221 __u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 5222 }; 5223 5224 enum nl80211_txrate_gi { 5225 NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI, 5226 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI, 5227 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI, 5228 }; 5229 5230 /** 5231 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band 5232 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band 5233 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz) 5234 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz) 5235 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz) 5236 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs 5237 * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder) 5238 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace 5239 * since newer kernel versions may support more bands 5240 */ 5241 enum nl80211_band { 5242 NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, 5243 NL80211_BAND_5GHZ, 5244 NL80211_BAND_60GHZ, 5245 NL80211_BAND_6GHZ, 5246 NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ, 5247 NL80211_BAND_LC, 5248 5249 NUM_NL80211_BANDS, 5250 }; 5251 5252 /** 5253 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state 5254 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled 5255 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled 5256 */ 5257 enum nl80211_ps_state { 5258 NL80211_PS_DISABLED, 5259 NL80211_PS_ENABLED, 5260 }; 5261 5262 /** 5263 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes 5264 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid 5265 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies 5266 * the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero 5267 * to disable. Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is 5268 * set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of 5269 * threshold values in dBm. Events will be sent when the RSSI value 5270 * crosses any of the thresholds. 5271 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies 5272 * the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a 5273 * new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation). 5274 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event 5275 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many 5276 * consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer 5277 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures 5278 * during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an 5279 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and 5280 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated. 5281 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given 5282 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is 5283 * checked. 5284 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic 5285 * interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and 5286 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an 5287 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting. 5288 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon 5289 * loss event 5290 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the 5291 * RSSI threshold event. 5292 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal 5293 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute 5294 */ 5295 enum nl80211_attr_cqm { 5296 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID, 5297 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD, 5298 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST, 5299 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT, 5300 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT, 5301 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE, 5302 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS, 5303 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL, 5304 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5305 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL, 5306 5307 /* keep last */ 5308 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST, 5309 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1 5310 }; 5311 5312 /** 5313 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event 5314 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the 5315 * configured threshold 5316 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the 5317 * configured threshold 5318 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent) 5319 */ 5320 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event { 5321 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW, 5322 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH, 5323 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5324 }; 5325 5326 5327 /** 5328 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment 5329 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power 5330 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter 5331 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter 5332 */ 5333 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting { 5334 NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC, 5335 NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED, 5336 NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED, 5337 }; 5338 5339 /** 5340 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state 5341 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID 5342 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID 5343 */ 5344 enum nl80211_tid_config { 5345 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE, 5346 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE, 5347 }; 5348 5349 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type 5350 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate 5351 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter 5352 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter 5353 */ 5354 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting { 5355 NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC, 5356 NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED, 5357 NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED, 5358 }; 5359 5360 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration. 5361 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values 5362 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported 5363 * for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic 5364 * (%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE). 5365 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but 5366 * per peer instead. 5367 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates 5368 * that the new configuration overrides all previous peer 5369 * configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations 5370 * should be left untouched. 5371 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7) 5372 * Its type is u16. 5373 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID. 5374 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config. 5375 * Its type is u8. 5376 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame 5377 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5378 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and 5379 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5380 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5381 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame 5382 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5383 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and 5384 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5385 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5386 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 5387 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5388 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5389 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs 5390 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using 5391 * the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5392 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 5393 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5394 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5395 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful 5396 * to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used 5397 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using 5398 * the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting. 5399 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied 5400 * with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES. 5401 * configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected 5402 * station. 5403 */ 5404 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr { 5405 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 5406 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD, 5407 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP, 5408 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP, 5409 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE, 5410 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, 5411 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK, 5412 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT, 5413 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG, 5414 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL, 5415 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL, 5416 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL, 5417 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE, 5418 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE, 5419 5420 /* keep last */ 5421 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 5422 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 5423 }; 5424 5425 /** 5426 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute 5427 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5428 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has 5429 * a zero bit are ignored 5430 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have 5431 * a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds 5432 * to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are 5433 * in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern 5434 * corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask. 5435 * For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where 5436 * xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of 5437 * twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01". 5438 * Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not 5439 * 802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked 5440 * first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched. 5441 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after 5442 * these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5443 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes 5444 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number 5445 */ 5446 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr { 5447 __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID, 5448 NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK, 5449 NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN, 5450 NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET, 5451 5452 NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT, 5453 MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1, 5454 }; 5455 5456 /** 5457 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information 5458 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported 5459 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern 5460 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern 5461 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5462 * 5463 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when 5464 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in 5465 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of 5466 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given 5467 * by the kernel to userspace. 5468 */ 5469 struct nl80211_pattern_support { 5470 __u32 max_patterns; 5471 __u32 min_pattern_len; 5472 __u32 max_pattern_len; 5473 __u32 max_pkt_offset; 5474 } __attribute__((packed)); 5475 5476 /* only for backward compatibility */ 5477 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID 5478 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5479 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN 5480 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET 5481 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT 5482 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT 5483 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support 5484 5485 /** 5486 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions 5487 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5488 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put 5489 * the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have 5490 * support for low-power operation already (flag) 5491 * Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if 5492 * any others are even supported by the device. 5493 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect 5494 * is detected is implementation-specific (flag) 5495 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed 5496 * by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag) 5497 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns 5498 * which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute 5499 * defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern. 5500 * Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with 5501 * each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is 5502 * done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the 5503 * pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU. 5504 * 5505 * In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute 5506 * carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support. 5507 * 5508 * When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based 5509 * index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed 5510 * to the kernel when configuring. 5511 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be 5512 * used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported 5513 * by the device (flag) 5514 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if 5515 * done by the device) (flag) 5516 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request 5517 * packet (flag) 5518 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag) 5519 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released 5520 * (on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag) 5521 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains 5522 * the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame 5523 * may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN 5524 * attribute contains the original length. 5525 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11 5526 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211 5527 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5528 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the 5529 * 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may 5530 * be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute 5531 * contains the original length. 5532 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3 5533 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023 5534 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5535 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section 5536 * "TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute 5537 * containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive 5538 * the TCP connection. 5539 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the 5540 * wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection 5541 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the 5542 * TCP connection was lost or failed to be established 5543 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only, 5544 * the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the 5545 * service 5546 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network 5547 * is detected. This is a nested attribute that contains the 5548 * same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN. It 5549 * specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the 5550 * channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan 5551 * results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets). This 5552 * attribute is also sent in a response to 5553 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets 5554 * supported by the driver (u32). 5555 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute 5556 * containing an array with information about what triggered the 5557 * wake up. If no elements are present in the array, it means 5558 * that the information is not available. If more than one 5559 * element is present, it means that more than one match 5560 * occurred. 5561 * Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains 5562 * one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional 5563 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute. At least one of 5564 * these attributes must be present. If 5565 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one 5566 * frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one 5567 * channel. 5568 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers 5569 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number 5570 * 5571 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and 5572 * to report the wakeup reason(s). 5573 */ 5574 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers { 5575 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID, 5576 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY, 5577 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT, 5578 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT, 5579 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN, 5580 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED, 5581 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE, 5582 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST, 5583 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE, 5584 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE, 5585 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211, 5586 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN, 5587 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023, 5588 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN, 5589 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION, 5590 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH, 5591 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST, 5592 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS, 5593 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT, 5594 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS, 5595 5596 /* keep last */ 5597 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG, 5598 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1 5599 }; 5600 5601 /** 5602 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup 5603 * 5604 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a 5605 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If 5606 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given 5607 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data 5608 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK. 5609 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence 5610 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also 5611 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive 5612 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc. 5613 * 5614 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the 5615 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern 5616 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the 5617 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is 5618 * also woken up. 5619 * 5620 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP 5621 * response packets might not go through correctly. 5622 */ 5623 5624 /** 5625 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence 5626 * @start: starting value 5627 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet 5628 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4 5629 * 5630 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the 5631 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet 5632 * in little endian. 5633 */ 5634 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq { 5635 __u32 start, offset, len; 5636 }; 5637 5638 /** 5639 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config 5640 * @offset: offset of token in packet 5641 * @len: length of each token 5642 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must 5643 * be a multiple of @len for this to make sense 5644 */ 5645 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token { 5646 __u32 offset, len; 5647 __u8 token_stream[]; 5648 }; 5649 5650 /** 5651 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features 5652 * @min_len: minimum token length 5653 * @max_len: maximum token length 5654 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream) 5655 */ 5656 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature { 5657 __u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize; 5658 }; 5659 5660 /** 5661 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters 5662 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5663 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order) 5664 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address 5665 * (in network byte order) 5666 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because 5667 * route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend, 5668 * and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it 5669 * might require ARP querying. 5670 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a 5671 * socket and port will be allocated 5672 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16) 5673 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte. 5674 * For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5675 * of the data payload. 5676 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration 5677 * (if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature 5678 * advertising it is just a flag 5679 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration, 5680 * see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see 5681 * &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature. 5682 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum 5683 * interval in feature advertising (u32) 5684 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a 5685 * u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5686 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for 5687 * feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5688 * but on the TCP payload only. 5689 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes 5690 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number 5691 */ 5692 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs { 5693 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID, 5694 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4, 5695 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4, 5696 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC, 5697 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT, 5698 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT, 5699 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD, 5700 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ, 5701 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN, 5702 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL, 5703 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD, 5704 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK, 5705 5706 /* keep last */ 5707 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP, 5708 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1 5709 }; 5710 5711 /** 5712 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information 5713 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported 5714 * @pat: packet pattern support information 5715 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5716 * 5717 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the 5718 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace. 5719 */ 5720 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support { 5721 __u32 max_rules; 5722 struct nl80211_pattern_support pat; 5723 __u32 max_delay; 5724 } __attribute__((packed)); 5725 5726 /** 5727 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute 5728 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5729 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing 5730 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence, 5731 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 5732 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched 5733 * after these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5734 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes 5735 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number 5736 */ 5737 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule { 5738 __NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID, 5739 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY, 5740 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION, 5741 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN, 5742 5743 /* keep last */ 5744 NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 5745 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1 5746 }; 5747 5748 /** 5749 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions 5750 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns 5751 * in a rule are matched. 5752 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns 5753 * in a rule are not matched. 5754 */ 5755 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition { 5756 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH, 5757 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH 5758 }; 5759 5760 /** 5761 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes 5762 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5763 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that 5764 * can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32) 5765 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a 5766 * flag attribute for each interface type in this set 5767 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes 5768 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number 5769 */ 5770 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs { 5771 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC, 5772 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX, 5773 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES, 5774 5775 /* keep last */ 5776 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT, 5777 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1 5778 }; 5779 5780 /** 5781 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes 5782 * 5783 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5784 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits 5785 * for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs. 5786 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of 5787 * interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't 5788 * apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed 5789 * in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE. 5790 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that 5791 * beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for 5792 * infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt 5793 * the infrastructure network's beacon interval. 5794 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many 5795 * different channels may be used within this group. 5796 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5797 * of supported channel widths for radar detection. 5798 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5799 * of supported regulatory regions for radar detection. 5800 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of 5801 * different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations 5802 * in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical). 5803 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes 5804 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number 5805 * 5806 * Examples: 5807 * limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2 5808 * => allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs 5809 * 5810 * numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8, 5811 * => allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd 5812 * 5813 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2 5814 * => allows two STAs on the same or on different channels 5815 * 5816 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4 5817 * => allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces 5818 * 5819 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained 5820 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate 5821 * that any of these groups must match. 5822 * 5823 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here, 5824 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always 5825 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid 5826 * interface type, the following group always exists: 5827 * numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1 5828 */ 5829 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs { 5830 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC, 5831 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS, 5832 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM, 5833 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH, 5834 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS, 5835 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS, 5836 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS, 5837 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD, 5838 5839 /* keep last */ 5840 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB, 5841 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1 5842 }; 5843 5844 5845 /** 5846 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine 5847 * 5848 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit 5849 * state of non existent mesh peer links 5850 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to 5851 * this mesh peer 5852 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received 5853 * from this mesh peer 5854 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been 5855 * received from this mesh peer 5856 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established 5857 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled 5858 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh 5859 * plink are discarded, except for authentication frames 5860 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states 5861 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states 5862 */ 5863 enum nl80211_plink_state { 5864 NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN, 5865 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT, 5866 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD, 5867 NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD, 5868 NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB, 5869 NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING, 5870 NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED, 5871 5872 /* keep last */ 5873 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES, 5874 MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1 5875 }; 5876 5877 /** 5878 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers 5879 * 5880 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action 5881 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment 5882 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer 5883 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions 5884 */ 5885 enum plink_actions { 5886 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION, 5887 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN, 5888 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK, 5889 5890 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS, 5891 }; 5892 5893 5894 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN 16 5895 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN 16 5896 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN 24 5897 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN 32 5898 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32 32 5899 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN 8 5900 5901 /** 5902 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload 5903 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5904 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary) 5905 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary) 5906 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary) 5907 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type) 5908 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal) 5909 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal) 5910 */ 5911 enum nl80211_rekey_data { 5912 __NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID, 5913 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK, 5914 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK, 5915 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR, 5916 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM, 5917 5918 /* keep last */ 5919 NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA, 5920 MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1 5921 }; 5922 5923 /** 5924 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID 5925 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in 5926 * Beacon frames) 5927 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element 5928 * in Beacon frames 5929 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID 5930 * element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID 5931 */ 5932 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid { 5933 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE, 5934 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN, 5935 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS 5936 }; 5937 5938 /** 5939 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes 5940 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5941 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format 5942 * is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field. 5943 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same 5944 * as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down). 5945 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal 5946 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute 5947 */ 5948 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr { 5949 __NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID, 5950 NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES, 5951 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP, 5952 5953 /* keep last */ 5954 __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST, 5955 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1 5956 }; 5957 5958 /** 5959 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates 5960 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5961 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher 5962 * priority) 5963 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets) 5964 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag) 5965 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes 5966 * (internal) 5967 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute 5968 * (internal) 5969 */ 5970 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr { 5971 __NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID, 5972 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX, 5973 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID, 5974 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH, 5975 5976 /* keep last */ 5977 NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 5978 MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1 5979 }; 5980 5981 /** 5982 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION 5983 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request 5984 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link 5985 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established 5986 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link 5987 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link 5988 */ 5989 enum nl80211_tdls_operation { 5990 NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ, 5991 NL80211_TDLS_SETUP, 5992 NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN, 5993 NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK, 5994 NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK, 5995 }; 5996 5997 /** 5998 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features 5999 * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver 6000 * when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during 6001 * "start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT. 6002 */ 6003 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features { 6004 NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD = 1 << 0, 6005 }; 6006 6007 /** 6008 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features 6009 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back 6010 * TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the 6011 * socket option. 6012 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates. 6013 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up 6014 * the connected inactive stations in AP mode. 6015 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested 6016 * to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from 6017 * cellular base stations. 6018 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only 6019 * here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility) 6020 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of 6021 * equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station 6022 * mode 6023 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan 6024 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported 6025 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif 6026 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting 6027 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform 6028 * OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only 6029 * for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied. 6030 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window 6031 * setting 6032 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic 6033 * powersave 6034 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state 6035 * transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver 6036 * doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding 6037 * stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated 6038 * state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag 6039 * they should be added before even sending the authentication reply 6040 * and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized 6041 * states using station flags. 6042 * Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add 6043 * stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated 6044 * stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask. 6045 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits 6046 * (HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set 6047 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh 6048 * Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for 6049 * beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is 6050 * still generated by the driver. 6051 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor 6052 * interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor 6053 * interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming 6054 * unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed. 6055 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic 6056 * channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the 6057 * lifetime of a BSS. 6058 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter 6059 * Set IE to probe requests. 6060 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE 6061 * to probe requests. 6062 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period 6063 * requests sent to it by an AP. 6064 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the 6065 * current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum 6066 * management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link 6067 * Measurement Report action frame. 6068 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout 6069 * estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used 6070 * to enable dynack. 6071 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial 6072 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6073 * even on HT connections that should be using more chains. 6074 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial 6075 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6076 * and then wake the rest up as required after, for example, 6077 * rts/cts handshake. 6078 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM 6079 * TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS 6080 * command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it 6081 * needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things. 6082 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring 6083 * the vif's MAC address upon creation. 6084 * See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h). 6085 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when 6086 * operating as a TDLS peer. 6087 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6088 * random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the 6089 * %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC 6090 * address mask/value will be used. 6091 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports 6092 * using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled 6093 * scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6094 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6095 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6096 * random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e. 6097 * scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6098 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6099 */ 6100 enum nl80211_feature_flags { 6101 NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS = 1 << 0, 6102 NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS = 1 << 1, 6103 NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER = 1 << 2, 6104 NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS = 1 << 3, 6105 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL = 1 << 4, 6106 NL80211_FEATURE_SAE = 1 << 5, 6107 NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN = 1 << 6, 6108 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH = 1 << 7, 6109 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN = 1 << 8, 6110 NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER = 1 << 9, 6111 NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN = 1 << 10, 6112 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN = 1 << 11, 6113 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS = 1 << 12, 6114 /* bit 13 is reserved */ 6115 NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS = 1 << 14, 6116 NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE = 1 << 15, 6117 NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM = 1 << 16, 6118 NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR = 1 << 17, 6119 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE = 1 << 18, 6120 NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 19, 6121 NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 20, 6122 NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET = 1 << 21, 6123 NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION = 1 << 22, 6124 NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION = 1 << 23, 6125 NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS = 1 << 24, 6126 NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS = 1 << 25, 6127 NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION = 1 << 26, 6128 NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE = 1 << 27, 6129 NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = 1 << 28, 6130 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 29, 6131 NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 30, 6132 NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1U << 31, 6133 }; 6134 6135 /** 6136 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features. 6137 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates. 6138 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can 6139 * request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with 6140 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set 6141 * the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if 6142 * NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized. 6143 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air 6144 * sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from 6145 * certain groups which can be configured by the 6146 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute, 6147 * or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the 6148 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute. 6149 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual 6150 * time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of 6151 * the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 6152 * (if available). 6153 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the 6154 * time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the 6155 * BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 6156 * (if available). 6157 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of 6158 * channel dwell time. 6159 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate 6160 * configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate. 6161 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate 6162 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates. 6163 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate 6164 * configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates. 6165 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup 6166 * with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode. 6167 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA 6168 * in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated. 6169 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports 6170 * randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated. 6171 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan 6172 * for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS 6173 * (%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI). 6174 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the 6175 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more 6176 * RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold. 6177 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key 6178 * authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 6179 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6180 * handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect 6181 * and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported. 6182 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way 6183 * handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host 6184 * and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not 6185 * be supported. 6186 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding 6187 * the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the 6188 * actual dwell time. 6189 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe 6190 * response 6191 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending 6192 * the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps. 6193 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports 6194 * probe request tx deferral and suppression 6195 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL 6196 * value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP. 6197 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan. 6198 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan. 6199 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan. 6200 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions. 6201 * Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself, 6202 * informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event, 6203 * channel change triggered by radar detection event. 6204 * No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to 6205 * "radar detected" event. 6206 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and 6207 * receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice. 6208 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports 6209 * (average) ACK signal strength reporting. 6210 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate 6211 * TXQs. 6212 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the 6213 * SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN. 6214 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data 6215 * except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested 6216 * by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag. 6217 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine 6218 * timing measurement responder role. 6219 * 6220 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are 6221 * able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys 6222 * if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or 6223 * freeze the connection. 6224 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for 6225 * Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016. 6226 * 6227 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime 6228 * fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness 6229 * scheduling. 6230 * 6231 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching 6232 * (set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode. 6233 * 6234 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports 6235 * filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds. 6236 * 6237 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power 6238 * to a station. 6239 * 6240 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in 6241 * station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command). 6242 * 6243 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev 6244 * with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using 6245 * vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case. 6246 * 6247 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL) 6248 * feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission 6249 * time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware. 6250 * 6251 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection 6252 * and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7. 6253 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon 6254 * protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons. 6255 * 6256 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the 6257 * forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then 6258 * handled as ordinary data frames. 6259 * 6260 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames 6261 * 6262 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations 6263 * in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state. 6264 * 6265 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations 6266 * are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly. 6267 * 6268 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and 6269 * reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to 6270 * report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be 6271 * included in the scan request. 6272 * 6273 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver 6274 * can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations. 6275 * 6276 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating 6277 * Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes. 6278 * 6279 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6280 * handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP 6281 * command). 6282 * 6283 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication 6284 * in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command). 6285 * 6286 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery 6287 * frames transmission 6288 * 6289 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports 6290 * unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission 6291 * 6292 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate 6293 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates. 6294 * 6295 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement 6296 * exchange protocol. 6297 * 6298 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement 6299 * exchange protocol. 6300 * 6301 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management 6302 * frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the 6303 * negotiation and range measurement procedure. 6304 * 6305 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision 6306 * detection and change announcemnts. 6307 * 6308 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports 6309 * FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response 6310 * frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using 6311 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 6312 * 6313 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC 6314 * detection. 6315 * 6316 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address 6317 * change without having to bring the underlying network device down 6318 * first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the 6319 * origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy 6320 * or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions 6321 * might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations 6322 * in progress, and no active connections. 6323 * 6324 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode. 6325 * 6326 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables 6327 * authentication, data encryption and message integrity. 6328 * 6329 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features. 6330 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index. 6331 */ 6332 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index { 6333 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS, 6334 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM, 6335 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER, 6336 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME, 6337 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 6338 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL, 6339 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 6340 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 6341 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT, 6342 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA, 6343 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA, 6344 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED, 6345 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 6346 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST, 6347 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD, 6348 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK, 6349 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X, 6350 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME, 6351 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6352 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE, 6353 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION, 6354 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL, 6355 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN, 6356 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN, 6357 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN, 6358 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD, 6359 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 6360 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6361 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 6362 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6363 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS, 6364 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN, 6365 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT, 6366 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0, 6367 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER, 6368 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS, 6369 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING, 6370 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, 6371 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID, 6372 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR, 6373 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD, 6374 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD, 6375 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL, 6376 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION, 6377 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 6378 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT, 6379 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA, 6380 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS, 6381 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT, 6382 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 6383 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS, 6384 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION, 6385 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK, 6386 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP, 6387 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY, 6388 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6389 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE, 6390 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF, 6391 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT, 6392 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE, 6393 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR, 6394 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD, 6395 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 6396 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE, 6397 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT, 6398 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN, 6399 6400 /* add new features before the definition below */ 6401 NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 6402 MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1 6403 }; 6404 6405 /** 6406 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported 6407 * protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW. 6408 * To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute. 6409 * Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported 6410 * protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a 6411 * supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded 6412 * to the host. 6413 * 6414 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1 6415 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2 6416 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P 6417 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u 6418 */ 6419 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr { 6420 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS = 1<<0, 6421 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 = 1<<1, 6422 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P = 1<<2, 6423 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U = 1<<3, 6424 }; 6425 6426 /** 6427 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons 6428 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be 6429 * handled by the AP is reached. 6430 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL. 6431 */ 6432 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason { 6433 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS, 6434 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT, 6435 }; 6436 6437 /** 6438 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons 6439 * 6440 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified. 6441 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out. 6442 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out. 6443 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out. 6444 */ 6445 enum nl80211_timeout_reason { 6446 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED, 6447 NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN, 6448 NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH, 6449 NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC, 6450 }; 6451 6452 /** 6453 * enum nl80211_scan_flags - scan request control flags 6454 * 6455 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling 6456 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN 6457 * requests. 6458 * 6459 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and 6460 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only 6461 * one of them can be used in the request. 6462 * 6463 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority 6464 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning 6465 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured 6466 * as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is 6467 * dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames 6468 * will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only 6469 * when really needed 6470 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or 6471 * for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the 6472 * flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and 6473 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only 6474 * the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder 6475 * randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits, 6476 * locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed. 6477 * This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check 6478 * the nl80211 feature flags for the device. 6479 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS 6480 * request parameters IE in the probe request 6481 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses 6482 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at 6483 * rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel, 6484 * only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate. 6485 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request 6486 * tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms) 6487 * and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame, 6488 * Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers 6489 * a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of 6490 * SSID and/or RSSI. 6491 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to 6492 * accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the 6493 * scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver 6494 * implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get 6495 * impacted with this flag. 6496 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume 6497 * optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to 6498 * optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag. 6499 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan 6500 * results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum 6501 * possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best 6502 * possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning. 6503 * Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag. 6504 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe 6505 * request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being 6506 * possible. 6507 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to 6508 * only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless 6509 * added by userspace explicitly.) 6510 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with 6511 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means 6512 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included. 6513 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for colocated APs reported by 6514 * 2.4/5 GHz APs 6515 */ 6516 enum nl80211_scan_flags { 6517 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY = 1<<0, 6518 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH = 1<<1, 6519 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP = 1<<2, 6520 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR = 1<<3, 6521 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME = 1<<4, 6522 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<5, 6523 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE = 1<<6, 6524 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION = 1<<7, 6525 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN = 1<<8, 6526 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER = 1<<9, 6527 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY = 1<<10, 6528 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN = 1<<11, 6529 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT = 1<<12, 6530 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ = 1<<13, 6531 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ = 1<<14, 6532 }; 6533 6534 /** 6535 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy 6536 * 6537 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by 6538 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to 6539 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. 6540 * 6541 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are 6542 * listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed 6543 * in ACL to authenticate. 6544 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed 6545 * in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL. 6546 */ 6547 enum nl80211_acl_policy { 6548 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED, 6549 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED, 6550 }; 6551 6552 /** 6553 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode 6554 * 6555 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode) 6556 * 6557 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas). 6558 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna) 6559 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and 6560 * turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS). 6561 */ 6562 enum nl80211_smps_mode { 6563 NL80211_SMPS_OFF, 6564 NL80211_SMPS_STATIC, 6565 NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 6566 6567 __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST, 6568 NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1 6569 }; 6570 6571 /** 6572 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation 6573 * 6574 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace 6575 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC) 6576 * 6577 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is 6578 * now unusable. 6579 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished, 6580 * the channel is now available. 6581 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no 6582 * change to the channel status. 6583 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is 6584 * over, channel becomes usable. 6585 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this 6586 * non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must 6587 * be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not 6588 * applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever. 6589 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started, 6590 * should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled. 6591 */ 6592 enum nl80211_radar_event { 6593 NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED, 6594 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED, 6595 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED, 6596 NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED, 6597 NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED, 6598 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED, 6599 }; 6600 6601 /** 6602 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels 6603 * 6604 * Channel states used by the DFS code. 6605 * 6606 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability 6607 * check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS. 6608 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it 6609 * is therefore marked as not available. 6610 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available. 6611 */ 6612 enum nl80211_dfs_state { 6613 NL80211_DFS_USABLE, 6614 NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE, 6615 NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE, 6616 }; 6617 6618 /** 6619 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features 6620 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting 6621 * wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute 6622 * %NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the 6623 * wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or 6624 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV. 6625 */ 6626 enum nl80211_protocol_features { 6627 NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP = 1 << 0, 6628 }; 6629 6630 /** 6631 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers 6632 * 6633 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified. 6634 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol. 6635 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol. 6636 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol. 6637 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last. 6638 */ 6639 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id { 6640 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC, 6641 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP, 6642 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL, 6643 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA, 6644 /* add other protocols before this one */ 6645 NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO 6646 }; 6647 6648 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */ 6649 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION 5000 /* msec */ 6650 6651 /** 6652 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame. 6653 * 6654 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt() 6655 * 6656 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver. 6657 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload 6658 * the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that 6659 * advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace 6660 * to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE). 6661 */ 6662 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags { 6663 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0, 6664 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1, 6665 }; 6666 6667 /* 6668 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set 6669 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated 6670 * yet, so that's not valid so far) 6671 */ 6672 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX 0x80000000 6673 6674 /** 6675 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data 6676 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the 6677 * value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID 6678 * may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be 6679 * added to this file when needed. 6680 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command 6681 */ 6682 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info { 6683 __u32 vendor_id; 6684 __u32 subcmd; 6685 }; 6686 6687 /** 6688 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags. 6689 * 6690 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need 6691 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames. 6692 * 6693 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable. 6694 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable. 6695 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable. 6696 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable. 6697 */ 6698 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability { 6699 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0, 6700 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1, 6701 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2, 6702 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3, 6703 }; 6704 6705 /** 6706 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan 6707 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 6708 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In 6709 * seconds (u32). 6710 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this 6711 * scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute 6712 * because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will 6713 * make the scan plan meaningless. 6714 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number 6715 * currently defined 6716 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use 6717 */ 6718 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan { 6719 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID, 6720 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 6721 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 6722 6723 /* keep last */ 6724 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST, 6725 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX = 6726 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1 6727 }; 6728 6729 /** 6730 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters. 6731 * 6732 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value 6733 * of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band. 6734 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB. 6735 */ 6736 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust { 6737 __u8 band; 6738 __s8 delta; 6739 } __attribute__((packed)); 6740 6741 /** 6742 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection. 6743 * 6744 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved. 6745 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection 6746 * is requested. 6747 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS 6748 * selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred. 6749 * When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver 6750 * shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of 6751 * this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32). 6752 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 6753 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 6754 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 6755 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 6756 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number. 6757 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use. 6758 * 6759 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT 6760 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour 6761 * which the driver shall use. 6762 */ 6763 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr { 6764 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID, 6765 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI, 6766 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF, 6767 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 6768 6769 /* keep last */ 6770 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 6771 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 6772 }; 6773 6774 /** 6775 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type 6776 * 6777 * Defines the function type of a NAN function 6778 * 6779 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish 6780 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe 6781 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up 6782 */ 6783 enum nl80211_nan_function_type { 6784 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, 6785 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE, 6786 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, 6787 6788 /* keep last */ 6789 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST, 6790 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1, 6791 }; 6792 6793 /** 6794 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type 6795 * 6796 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames 6797 * 6798 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited 6799 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited 6800 */ 6801 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type { 6802 NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0, 6803 NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1, 6804 }; 6805 6806 /** 6807 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason 6808 * 6809 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function 6810 * 6811 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user 6812 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout 6813 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored 6814 */ 6815 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason { 6816 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST, 6817 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED, 6818 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR, 6819 }; 6820 6821 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6 6822 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff 6823 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff 6824 6825 /** 6826 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes 6827 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid 6828 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8). 6829 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as 6830 * specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute. 6831 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is 6832 * publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery 6833 * Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8. 6834 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited 6835 * publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to 6836 * the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag. 6837 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is 6838 * subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag. 6839 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up. 6840 * The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8. 6841 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type 6842 * is follow up. This is a u8. 6843 * The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. 6844 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the 6845 * follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute. 6846 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a 6847 * close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device. 6848 * This is a flag. 6849 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should 6850 * stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32. 6851 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service 6852 * specific info. This is a binary attribute. 6853 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute. 6854 * See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes. 6855 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested 6856 * attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6857 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a 6858 * nested attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6859 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function. 6860 * Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0. 6861 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason. 6862 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason. 6863 * 6864 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal 6865 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute 6866 */ 6867 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes { 6868 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID, 6869 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE, 6870 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID, 6871 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE, 6872 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST, 6873 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE, 6874 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID, 6875 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID, 6876 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST, 6877 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE, 6878 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL, 6879 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO, 6880 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF, 6881 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER, 6882 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER, 6883 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID, 6884 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON, 6885 6886 /* keep last */ 6887 NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR, 6888 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1 6889 }; 6890 6891 /** 6892 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes 6893 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid 6894 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set. 6895 * This is a flag. 6896 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if 6897 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary. 6898 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if 6899 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8. 6900 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if 6901 * and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested 6902 * attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address. 6903 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal 6904 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute 6905 */ 6906 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes { 6907 __NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID, 6908 NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE, 6909 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF, 6910 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX, 6911 NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS, 6912 6913 /* keep last */ 6914 NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR, 6915 NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1, 6916 }; 6917 6918 /** 6919 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes 6920 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid 6921 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the 6922 * match. This is a nested attribute. 6923 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 6924 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function 6925 * that caused the match. This is a nested attribute. 6926 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 6927 * 6928 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal 6929 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute 6930 */ 6931 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes { 6932 __NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID, 6933 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL, 6934 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER, 6935 6936 /* keep last */ 6937 NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR, 6938 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1 6939 }; 6940 6941 /** 6942 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external 6943 * authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION. 6944 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication. 6945 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication. 6946 */ 6947 enum nl80211_external_auth_action { 6948 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START, 6949 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT, 6950 }; 6951 6952 /** 6953 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement 6954 * responder attributes 6955 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 6956 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled 6957 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element 6958 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10), 6959 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 6960 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element 6961 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13), 6962 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 6963 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 6964 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute. 6965 */ 6966 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes { 6967 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 6968 6969 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED, 6970 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 6971 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 6972 6973 /* keep last */ 6974 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 6975 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1, 6976 }; 6977 6978 /* 6979 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 6980 * 6981 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS 6982 * when getting FTM responder statistics. 6983 * 6984 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 6985 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames 6986 * were ssfully answered (u32) 6987 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the 6988 * frames were successfully answered (u32) 6989 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32) 6990 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32) 6991 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32) 6992 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an 6993 * indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec) 6994 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers - 6995 * triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation 6996 * phase with the responder (u32) 6997 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests 6998 * - initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled 6999 * FTM slot (u32) 7000 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of 7001 * scheduled window (u32) 7002 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore 7003 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 7004 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute 7005 */ 7006 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats { 7007 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID, 7008 NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM, 7009 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM, 7010 NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM, 7011 NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM, 7012 NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM, 7013 NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC, 7014 NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7015 NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM, 7016 NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7017 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD, 7018 7019 /* keep last */ 7020 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST, 7021 NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1 7022 }; 7023 7024 /** 7025 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types 7026 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble 7027 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble 7028 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble 7029 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble 7030 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble 7031 */ 7032 enum nl80211_preamble { 7033 NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY, 7034 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT, 7035 NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT, 7036 NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG, 7037 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE, 7038 }; 7039 7040 /** 7041 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types 7042 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use 7043 * these numbers also for attributes 7044 * 7045 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement 7046 * 7047 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal 7048 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number 7049 */ 7050 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type { 7051 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID, 7052 7053 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM, 7054 7055 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES, 7056 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1 7057 }; 7058 7059 /** 7060 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status 7061 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully 7062 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused 7063 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out 7064 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent 7065 * reason may be available in the response data 7066 */ 7067 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status { 7068 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS, 7069 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED, 7070 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT, 7071 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE, 7072 }; 7073 7074 /** 7075 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes 7076 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7077 * 7078 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7079 * type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the 7080 * enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req. 7081 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported 7082 * (flag attribute) 7083 * 7084 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal 7085 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7086 */ 7087 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req { 7088 __NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7089 7090 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA, 7091 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF, 7092 7093 /* keep last */ 7094 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS, 7095 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1 7096 }; 7097 7098 /** 7099 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes 7100 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7101 * 7102 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7103 * type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums 7104 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp. 7105 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status 7106 * (using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.) 7107 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the 7108 * result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to 7109 * more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 7110 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface 7111 * doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured. 7112 * This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested 7113 * (u64, usec) 7114 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially 7115 * (*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but 7116 * the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single 7117 * result. 7118 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore 7119 * 7120 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal 7121 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7122 */ 7123 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp { 7124 __NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7125 7126 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA, 7127 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS, 7128 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME, 7129 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF, 7130 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL, 7131 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7132 7133 /* keep last */ 7134 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS, 7135 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1 7136 }; 7137 7138 /** 7139 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement 7140 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7141 * 7142 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address 7143 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level 7144 * attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc. 7145 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7146 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7147 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside. 7148 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7149 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7150 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside. 7151 * 7152 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal 7153 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7154 */ 7155 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs { 7156 __NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID, 7157 7158 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR, 7159 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN, 7160 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ, 7161 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP, 7162 7163 /* keep last */ 7164 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS, 7165 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1, 7166 }; 7167 7168 /** 7169 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes 7170 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7171 * 7172 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability 7173 * advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers 7174 * measurements can be done with in a single request 7175 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability 7176 * indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in 7177 * measurement results 7178 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability 7179 * indicating that MAC address randomization is supported. 7180 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device, 7181 * this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and 7182 * type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums 7183 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa. 7184 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is 7185 * meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the 7186 * sub-attributes taken from 7187 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs. 7188 * 7189 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal 7190 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7191 */ 7192 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs { 7193 __NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID, 7194 7195 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS, 7196 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF, 7197 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR, 7198 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA, 7199 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS, 7200 7201 /* keep last */ 7202 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR, 7203 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1 7204 }; 7205 7206 /** 7207 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities 7208 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7209 * 7210 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode 7211 * is supported 7212 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP 7213 * mode is supported 7214 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI 7215 * data can be requested during the measurement 7216 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic 7217 * location data can be requested during the measurement 7218 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits 7219 * from &enum nl80211_preamble. 7220 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from 7221 * &enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel 7222 * bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be 7223 * configured to allow for other measurements types with different 7224 * bandwidth requirement in the same measurement. 7225 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating 7226 * the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything 7227 * is valid) 7228 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating 7229 * the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid) 7230 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if 7231 * trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7232 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating 7233 * if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7234 * 7235 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal 7236 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7237 */ 7238 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa { 7239 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID, 7240 7241 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP, 7242 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP, 7243 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI, 7244 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC, 7245 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES, 7246 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS, 7247 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT, 7248 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7249 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7250 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7251 7252 /* keep last */ 7253 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR, 7254 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1 7255 }; 7256 7257 /** 7258 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes 7259 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7260 * 7261 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag) 7262 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see 7263 * &enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32) 7264 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in 7265 * 802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element" 7266 * (u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7267 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units 7268 * of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0) 7269 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016 7270 * Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with 7271 * default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7272 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames 7273 * requested per burst 7274 * (u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference") 7275 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries 7276 * (u8, default 3) 7277 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag) 7278 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data 7279 * (flag) 7280 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging 7281 * measurement (flag). 7282 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are 7283 * mutually exclusive. 7284 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7285 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7286 * ranging will be used. 7287 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based 7288 * ranging measurement (flag) 7289 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are 7290 * mutually exclusive. 7291 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7292 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7293 * ranging will be used. 7294 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only 7295 * valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or 7296 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7297 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the 7298 * responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED 7299 * or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7300 * 7301 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal 7302 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7303 */ 7304 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req { 7305 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7306 7307 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP, 7308 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE, 7309 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7310 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD, 7311 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7312 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7313 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES, 7314 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI, 7315 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC, 7316 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7317 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7318 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK, 7319 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR, 7320 7321 /* keep last */ 7322 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR, 7323 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1 7324 }; 7325 7326 /** 7327 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons 7328 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used 7329 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder 7330 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement 7331 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is 7332 * on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd 7333 * try and get no response) 7334 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM 7335 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps 7336 * received 7337 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry 7338 * later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME) 7339 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed 7340 * by the peer and are no longer supported 7341 */ 7342 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons { 7343 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED, 7344 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE, 7345 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED, 7346 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL, 7347 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE, 7348 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP, 7349 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 7350 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS, 7351 }; 7352 7353 /** 7354 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes 7355 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7356 * 7357 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason 7358 * (u32, optional) 7359 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported 7360 * as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and 7361 * the top level will indicate partial results (u32) 7362 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames 7363 * transmitted (u32, optional) 7364 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames 7365 * that were acknowleged (u32, optional) 7366 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the 7367 * busy peer (u32, seconds) 7368 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent 7369 * used by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7370 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by 7371 * the responder (similar to request, u8) 7372 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used 7373 * by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7374 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action 7375 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7376 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action 7377 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7378 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the 7379 * FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info 7380 * attributes) 7381 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM 7382 * action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs) 7383 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional 7384 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7385 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that 7386 * standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7387 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds, 7388 * optional) 7389 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional 7390 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7391 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note 7392 * that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7393 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional) 7394 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional); 7395 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7396 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7397 * Type 8. 7398 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer 7399 * (binary, optional); 7400 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7401 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7402 * Type 11. 7403 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only 7404 * 7405 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal 7406 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7407 */ 7408 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp { 7409 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7410 7411 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON, 7412 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX, 7413 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS, 7414 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES, 7415 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME, 7416 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7417 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7418 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7419 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG, 7420 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD, 7421 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE, 7422 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE, 7423 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG, 7424 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE, 7425 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD, 7426 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG, 7427 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE, 7428 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD, 7429 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 7430 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 7431 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7432 7433 /* keep last */ 7434 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR, 7435 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1 7436 }; 7437 7438 /** 7439 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes 7440 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7441 * 7442 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset. 7443 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset. 7444 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum 7445 * tx power offset. 7446 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color 7447 * values used by members of the SRG. 7448 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial 7449 * BSSID values used by members of the SRG. 7450 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element. 7451 * 7452 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7453 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute. 7454 */ 7455 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes { 7456 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID, 7457 7458 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET, 7459 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET, 7460 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET, 7461 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 7462 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP, 7463 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL, 7464 7465 /* keep last */ 7466 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST, 7467 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7468 }; 7469 7470 /** 7471 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes 7472 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7473 * 7474 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color. 7475 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled. 7476 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used.. 7477 * 7478 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7479 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute. 7480 */ 7481 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes { 7482 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID, 7483 7484 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR, 7485 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED, 7486 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL, 7487 7488 /* keep last */ 7489 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST, 7490 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7491 }; 7492 7493 /** 7494 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes 7495 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7496 * 7497 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag 7498 * attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in 7499 * %NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES 7500 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported 7501 * AKM suites for the specified interface types. 7502 * 7503 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7504 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute. 7505 */ 7506 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes { 7507 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID, 7508 7509 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES, 7510 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES, 7511 7512 /* keep last */ 7513 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST, 7514 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7515 }; 7516 7517 /** 7518 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration 7519 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 7520 * 7521 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7522 * 7523 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU). 7524 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit) 7525 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7526 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit) 7527 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action 7528 * frame including the headers. 7529 * 7530 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7531 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7532 */ 7533 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes { 7534 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID, 7535 7536 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN, 7537 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX, 7538 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL, 7539 7540 /* keep last */ 7541 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST, 7542 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1 7543 }; 7544 7545 /* 7546 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and 7547 * mandatory fields. 7548 */ 7549 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42 7550 7551 /** 7552 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe 7553 * response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz. 7554 * 7555 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7556 * 7557 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7558 * Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 7559 * 26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). 7560 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 7561 * frame template (binary). 7562 * 7563 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7564 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7565 */ 7566 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes { 7567 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7568 7569 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT, 7570 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL, 7571 7572 /* keep last */ 7573 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 7574 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX = 7575 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1 7576 }; 7577 7578 /** 7579 * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 7580 * derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is 7581 * used. 7582 * 7583 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that 7584 * attribute is not present from userspace. 7585 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only 7586 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only 7587 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element 7588 * can be used. 7589 */ 7590 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism { 7591 NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED, 7592 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK, 7593 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT, 7594 NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH, 7595 }; 7596 7597 /** 7598 * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs 7599 * 7600 * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit 7601 * 7602 */ 7603 enum nl80211_sar_type { 7604 NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER, 7605 7606 /* add new type here */ 7607 7608 /* Keep last */ 7609 NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE, 7610 }; 7611 7612 /** 7613 * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec 7614 * 7615 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type. 7616 * 7617 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power 7618 * limit specifications. Each specification contains a set 7619 * of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 7620 * 7621 * For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER 7622 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX. 7623 * 7624 * For sar_capa dump, it contains array of 7625 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ 7626 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ. 7627 * 7628 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7629 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute 7630 * 7631 * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC 7632 */ 7633 enum nl80211_sar_attrs { 7634 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID, 7635 7636 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE, 7637 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS, 7638 7639 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST, 7640 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7641 }; 7642 7643 /** 7644 * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs 7645 * 7646 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual 7647 * power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is 7648 * NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm). 7649 * 0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range. 7650 * 7651 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the 7652 * index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation 7653 * is applied to this range. 7654 * 7655 * Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver, 7656 * and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't 7657 * have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the 7658 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any 7659 * value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power 7660 * limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range. 7661 * It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation. 7662 * 7663 * Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation. 7664 * 7665 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start 7666 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7667 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7668 * 7669 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end 7670 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7671 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7672 * 7673 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal 7674 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute 7675 */ 7676 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs { 7677 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID, 7678 7679 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER, 7680 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX, 7681 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ, 7682 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ, 7683 7684 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST, 7685 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1, 7686 }; 7687 7688 /** 7689 * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced 7690 * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode. 7691 * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for 7692 * MBSSID and EMA. 7693 * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the 7694 * features. 7695 * 7696 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7697 * 7698 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise 7699 * the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver. 7700 * Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting 7701 * wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2. 7702 * 7703 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel 7704 * to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver 7705 * if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace 7706 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to 7707 * a non-zero value. 7708 * 7709 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of 7710 * this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set. 7711 * Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for 7712 * all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible 7713 * for using unique indices for the interfaces. 7714 * Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1. 7715 * 7716 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for 7717 * a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of 7718 * the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface 7719 * indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up 7720 * is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match 7721 * the interface index of the same. 7722 * 7723 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature. 7724 * Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support 7725 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero. 7726 * 7727 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7728 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7729 */ 7730 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes { 7731 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 7732 7733 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES, 7734 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY, 7735 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX, 7736 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX, 7737 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA, 7738 7739 /* keep last */ 7740 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST, 7741 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7742 }; 7743 7744 /** 7745 * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 7746 * 7747 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external 7748 * authentication. 7749 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query 7750 * procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises 7751 * %NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall 7752 * ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by 7753 * userspace. 7754 */ 7755 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags { 7756 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = 1 << 0, 7757 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT = 1 << 1, 7758 }; 7759 7760 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */ 7761